REF615 Application Manual
REF615 Application Manual
REF615 Application Manual
This document and parts thereof must not be reproduced or copied without written permission from
ABB, and the contents thereof must not be imparted to a third party, nor used for any unauthorized
purpose.
The software or hardware described in this document is furnished under a license and may be used,
copied, or disclosed only in accordance with the terms of such license.
Trademarks
ABB and Relion are registered trademarks of the ABB Group. All other brand or product names
mentioned in this document may be trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective holders.
Warranty
Please inquire about the terms of warranty from your nearest ABB representative.
www.abb.com/relion
Disclaimer
The data, examples and diagrams in this manual are included solely for the concept or product
description and are not to be deemed as a statement of guaranteed properties. All persons responsible
for applying the equipment addressed in this manual must satisfy themselves that each intended
application is suitable and acceptable, including that any applicable safety or other operational
requirements are complied with. In particular, any risks in applications where a system failure and/or
product failure would create a risk for harm to property or persons (including but not limited to
personal injuries or death) shall be the sole responsibility of the person or entity applying the
equipment, and those so responsible are hereby requested to ensure that all measures are taken to
exclude or mitigate such risks.
This product has been designed to be connected and communicate data and information via a network
interface which should be connected to a secure network. It is the sole responsibility of the person
or entity responsible for network administration to ensure a secure connection to the network and
to take the necessary measures (such as, but not limited to, installation of firewalls, application of
authentication measures, encryption of data, installation of anti virus programs, etc.) to protect the
product and the network, its system and interface included, against any kind of security breaches,
unauthorized access, interference, intrusion, leakage and/or theft of data or information. ABB is not
liable for any such damages and/or losses.
This document has been carefully checked by ABB but deviations cannot be completely ruled out. In
case any errors are detected, the reader is kindly requested to notify the manufacturer. Other than
under explicit contractual commitments, in no event shall ABB be responsible or liable for any loss or
damage resulting from the use of this manual or the application of the equipment.
Conformity
UK legislations:
• Electromagnetic Compatibility Regulations 2016
• Electrical Equipment (Safety) Regulations 2016
• The Restriction of the Use of Certain Hazardous Substances in Electrical and Electronic Equipment
Regulations 2012
These conformities are the result of tests conducted by the third-party testing in accordance with
the product standard EN / BS EN 60255-26 for the EMC directive / regulation, and with the product
standards EN / BS EN 60255-1 and EN / BS EN 60255-27 for the low voltage directive / safety regulation.
The product is designed in accordance with the international standards of the IEC 60255 series.
Contents
Contents
1 Introduction............................................................................................. 10
1.1 This manual.............................................................................................................................................10
1.2 Intended audience.................................................................................................................................10
1.3 Product documentation....................................................................................................................... 11
1.3.1 Product documentation set.................................................................................................11
1.3.2 Document revision history...................................................................................................12
1.3.3 Related documentation........................................................................................................12
1.4 Symbols and conventions.................................................................................................................... 13
1.4.1 Symbols................................................................................................................................... 13
1.4.2 Document conventions........................................................................................................ 13
1.4.3 Functions, codes and symbols........................................................................................... 15
2 REF615 overview......................................................................................19
2.1 Overview..................................................................................................................................................19
2.1.1 Product version history........................................................................................................ 19
2.1.2 PCM600 and relay connectivity package version............................................................21
2.2 Operation functionality........................................................................................................................22
2.2.1 Optional functions................................................................................................................ 22
2.3 Physical hardware..................................................................................................................................22
2.4 Local HMI.................................................................................................................................................24
2.4.1 Display..................................................................................................................................... 25
2.4.2 LEDs......................................................................................................................................... 26
2.4.3 Keypad.....................................................................................................................................26
2.5 Web HMI.................................................................................................................................................. 27
2.6 Authorization ........................................................................................................................................ 28
2.6.1 Audit trail................................................................................................................................ 29
2.7 Communication .....................................................................................................................................31
2.7.1 Self-healing Ethernet ring....................................................................................................32
2.7.2 Ethernet redundancy............................................................................................................ 33
2.7.3 Process bus............................................................................................................................ 35
2.7.4 Secure communication.........................................................................................................37
REF615 7
Application Manual
Contents
8 REF615
Application Manual
Contents
6 Glossary..................................................................................................366
REF615 9
Application Manual
Introduction 1MRS756378 U
1 Introduction
10 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Introduction
Figure 1: The intended use of documents during the product life cycle
REF615 11
Application Manual
Introduction 1MRS756378 U
Download the latest documents from the ABB Web site http://
www.abb.com/relion.
12 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Introduction
1.4.1 Symbols
The electrical warning icon indicates the presence of a hazard which
could result in electrical shock.
The warning icon indicates the presence of a hazard which could result in
personal injury.
The tip icon indicates advice on, for example, how to design your project
or how to use a certain function.
REF615 13
Application Manual
Introduction 1MRS756378 U
The function can be enabled and disabled with the Operation setting.
• Parameter values are indicated with quotation marks.
The corresponding parameter values are "On" and "Off".
• IED input/output messages and monitored data names are shown in Courier
font.
When the function starts, the START output is set to TRUE.
• This document assumes that the parameter setting visibility is "Advanced".
14 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Introduction
REF615 15
Application Manual
Introduction 1MRS756378 U
16 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Introduction
REF615 17
Application Manual
Introduction 1MRS756378 U
18 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
2 REF615 overview
2.1 Overview
REF615 is a dedicated feeder protection and control relay designed for the
protection, control, measurement and supervision of utility substations and
industrial power systems including radial, looped and meshed distribution
networks with or without distributed power generation. REF615 is a member
®
of ABB’s Relion product family and part of its 615 protection and control
product series. The 615 series relays are characterized by their compactness and
withdrawable-unit design.
Re-engineered from the ground up, the 615 series has been designed to unleash
the full potential of the IEC 61850 standard for communication and interoperability
between substation automation devices.
The relay provides main protection for overhead lines and cable feeders in
distribution networks. The relay is also used as back-up protection in applications,
where an independent and redundant protection system is required.
Depending on the chosen standard configuration, the relay is adapted for the
protection of overhead line and cable feeders in isolated neutral, resistance
earthed, compensated and solidly earthed networks. Once the standard
configuration relay has been given the application-specific settings, it can directly
be put into service.
The 615 series relays support a range of communication protocols including
IEC 61850 with Edition 2 support, process bus according to IEC 61850-9-2 LE,
®
IEC 60870-5-103, Modbus and DNP3. Profibus DPV1 communication protocol is
supported by using the protocol converter SPA-ZC 302.
REF615 19
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
20 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
REF615 21
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
- AR Sequence Visualizer
- Label Printing
- IEC 61850 Configuration
- IED Configuration Migration
Download connectivity packages from the ABB Web site www.abb.com/
substationautomation or directly with Update Manager in PCM600.
22 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
1 The 0.2/1 A input is normally used in applications requiring sensitive earth-fault protection and
featuring core-balance current transformers.
REF615 23
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
Rated values of the current and voltage inputs are basic setting parameters of the
protection relay. The binary input thresholds are selectable within the range 16…176
V DC by adjusting the binary input setting parameters.
The connection diagrams of different hardware modules are presented in this
manual.
See the installation manual for more information about the case and the
plug-in unit.
24 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
REF615
Overcurrent
Dir. earth-fault
Voltage protection
Phase unbalance
Thermal overload
Breaker failure
Disturb. rec. Triggered
CB condition monitoring
Supervision
Arc detected
Autoreclose shot in progr.
2.4.1 Display
The LHMI includes a graphical display that supports two character sizes. The
character size depends on the selected language. The amount of characters and
rows fitting the view depends on the character size.
REF615 25
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
3 4
1 Header 3 Content
2 Icon 4 Scroll bar (displayed when needed)
Figure 3: Display layout
2.4.2 LEDs
The LHMI includes three protection indicators above the display: Ready, Start and
Trip.
There are 11 matrix programmable LEDs on front of the LHMI. The LEDs can be
configured with PCM600 and the operation mode can be selected with the LHMI,
WHMI or PCM600.
2.4.3 Keypad
The LHMI keypad contains push buttons which are used to navigate in different
views or menus. With the push buttons you can give open or close commands
to objects in the primary circuit, for example, a circuit breaker, a contactor or
a disconnector. The push buttons are also used to acknowledge alarms, reset
indications, provide help and switch between local and remote control mode.
26 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
Figure 4: LHMI keypad with object control, navigation and command push buttons
and RJ-45 communication port
REF615 27
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
2.6 Authorization
Four user categories have been predefined for the LHMI and the WHMI, each with
different rights and default passwords.
The default passwords in the protection relay delivered from the factory can be
changed with Administrator user rights.
User authorization is disabled by default for LHMI but WHMI always uses
authorization.
28 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
REF615 29
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
PCM600 Event Viewer can be used to view the audit trail events and process related
events. Audit trail events are visible through dedicated Security events view. Since
only the administrator has the right to read audit trail, authorization must be used
in PCM600. The audit trail cannot be reset, but PCM600 Event Viewer can filter
data. Audit trail events can be configured to be visible also in LHMI/WHMI Event list
together with process related events.
To expose the audit trail events through Event list, define the Authority
logging level parameter via Configuration > Authorization > Security.
This exposes audit trail events to all users.
30 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
2.7 Communication
The protection relay supports a range of communication protocols including
®
IEC 61850, IEC 61850-9-2 LE, IEC 60870-5-103, Modbus and DNP3. Profibus
DPV1 communication protocol is supported by using the protocol converter
SPA-ZC 302. Operational information and controls are available through these
protocols. However, some communication functionality, for example, horizontal
communication between the protection relays, is only enabled by the IEC 61850
communication protocol.
The IEC 61850 communication implementation supports all monitoring and control
functions. Additionally, parameter settings, disturbance recordings and fault
records can be accessed using the IEC 61850 protocol. Disturbance recordings
are available to any Ethernet-based application in the IEC 60255-24 standard
COMTRADE file format. The protection relay can send and receive binary signals
from other devices (so-called horizontal communication) using the IEC 61850-8-1
GOOSE profile, where the highest performance class with a total transmission time
REF615 31
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
Client A Client B
Network A
Network B
32 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
PRP
Each PRP node, called a double attached node with PRP (DAN), is attached to
two independent LANs operated in parallel. These parallel networks in PRP are
called LAN A and LAN B. The networks are completely separated to ensure failure
independence, and they can have different topologies. Both networks operate in
parallel, thus providing zero-time recovery and continuous checking of redundancy
to avoid communication failures. Non-PRP nodes, called single attached nodes
(SANs), are either attached to one network only (and can therefore communicate
only with DANs and SANs attached to the same network), or are attached through a
redundancy box, a device that behaves like a DAN.
REF615 33
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
COM600
SCADA
HSR
HSR applies the PRP principle of parallel operation to a single ring, treating the two
directions as two virtual LANs. For each frame sent, a node, DAN, sends two frames,
one over each port. Both frames circulate in opposite directions over the ring and
each node forwards the frames it receives, from one port to the other. When the
originating node receives a frame sent to itself, it discards that to avoid loops;
therefore, no ring protocol is needed. Individually attached nodes, SANs, such as
laptops and printers, must be attached through a “redundancy box” that acts as a
ring element. For example, a 615 or 620 series protection relay with HSR support can
be used as a redundancy box.
34 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
REF615 35
Application Manual
REF615 overview 1MRS756378 U
Common Ethernet
Station bus (IEC 61850-8-1), process bus (IEC 61850-9-2 LE) and IEEE 1588 v2 time synchronization
GOOSE
GOOSE
GOOSE
GOOSE
GOOSE
GOOSE
GOOSE
SMV
SMV
SMV
SMV
SMV
SMV
SMV
Figure 9: Process bus application of voltage sharing and synchrocheck
The 615 series supports IEC 61850 process bus with sampled values of analog
currents and voltages. The measured values are transferred as sampled values
using the IEC 61850-9-2 LE protocol which uses the same physical Ethernet network
as the IEC 61850-8-1 station bus. The intended application for sampled values is
sharing the measured voltages from one 615 series protection relay to other devices
with phase voltage based functions and 9-2 support.
The 615 series protection relays with process bus based applications use IEEE
1588 v2 Precision Time Protocol (PTP) according to IEEE C37.238-2011 Power
Profile for high accuracy time synchronization. With IEEE 1588 v2, the cabling
infrastructure requirement is reduced by allowing time synchronization information
to be transported over the same Ethernet network as the data communications.
36 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 overview
Primary Secondary
IEEE 1588 v2 IEEE 1588 v2
master clock master clock
(optional)
IEC 61850
HSR
SMV traffic
Backup 1588
master clock
Figure 10: Example network topology with process bus, redundancy and IEEE 1588
v2 time synchronization
The process bus option is available for all 615 series protection relays equipped
with phase voltage inputs. Another requirement is a communication card with IEEE
1588 v2 support (COM0031...COM0037). However, RED615 supports this option only
with the communication card variant having fiber optic station bus ports. See the
IEC 61850 engineering guide for detailed system requirements and configuration
details.
REF615 37
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
38 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 39
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3 One of the following can be ordered as an option: admittance-based E/F, wattmetric-based E/F
or harmonics-based E/F.
4 "Io measured" is always used.
5 "IoB measured" is always used.
40 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
6 Master trip is included and connected to the corresponding HSO in the configuration only when
the BIO0007 module is used. If additionally the ARC option is selected, ARCSARC is connected in
the configuration to the corresponding master trip input.
7 Power quality option includes current total demand distortion, voltage total harmonic distortion,
voltage variation and voltage unbalance.
8 Available only with IEC 61850-9-2
REF615 41
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
42 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
1, 2, ... = Number of included instances. The instances of a protection function represent the number of identical protection
function blocks available in the standard configuration.
() = optional
REF615 43
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
da dn
REF615
X120 X100
1 + 1
BI 1 Uaux
Positive 2
-
2
Current
Direction 3 3
BI 2
IRF
4
4 5
BI 3
P1
60 - PO1
5 210V
S1
Uo
6 N
6
2) 7
S2
7 1/5A
IL1
8 N PO2
P2 9 1/5A
IL2 8
10 N 9
11 1/5A 10
IL3 SO1
12 N
13 1/5A 11
Io 12
P1 S1
14 N 13
S2 SO2
P2
X110 14
1 16
BI 1 3)
PO3
2
17
3 15
BI 2 19
4 TCS1 18
5 20
BI 3 22
6
PO4
BI 4 21
7 23
TCS2 24
8
BI 5
9
X110
3)
BI 6 14
10
SO1
11 16
BI 7 15
12
17
SO2
BI 8
13 19
18
20
X130 SO3
1 1) 4) 22
BI 1 21
2 23
SO4
BI 2 24
3
4
BI 3
5 X130
10
BI 4 1) 4) SO1
6
12
7 11
BI 5 13
8
SO2
15
BI 6 14
9
16
SO3
18
17
X13
1) 1) Optional
Light sensor input 1
X130 module optional in REF615 conf B
X14 2) The IED features an automatic short-circuit
1) mechanism in the CT connector when plug-in
Light sensor input 2 unit is detached
3) REF615 conf B: BIO0005 module (8BI+4BO)
X15 Alternative module BIO0007 (8BI+3HSO)
1)
Light sensor input 3 4) REF615 conf B: BIO0006 module (6BI+3BO)
Alternative module RTD0001 (6RTD+2mA) 2
44 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
L1
L2
L3
Positive
Current REF615
Direction
X120 X100
1 + 1
BI 1 U aux
2 2
-
3 3
BI 2
IRF
4
4 5
BI 3
P1
PO1
5
S1 BI 4
6 6
S2
7 1/5A 2) 7
IL1
8 N PO2
P2 9 1/5A
IL2 8
10 N 9
11 1/5A 10
IL3 SO1
12 N
13 1/5A 11
Io 12
14 N 13
SO2
X110 14
1 3) 16
BI 1 PO3
2
17
3 15
BI 2
4 19
TCS1 18
5 20
BI 3 22
6
PO4
BI 4 21
7 23
TCS2 24
8
BI 5
9
3) X110
BI 6 14
10
SO1
11 16
BI 7
12 15
17
BI 8 SO2
13 19
18
20
SO3
X130
1) 4) 22
1 21
BI 1
2 23
SO4
BI 2 24
3
4
BI 3 X130
5
10
BI 4 1) 4) SO1
6
12
7 11
BI 5 13
8
SO2
15
BI 6 14
9
16
SO3
18
17
X13
1) 1) Optional
Light sensor input 1
X130 module optional in REF615 conf D
X14 2) The IED features an automatic short-circuit
1) mechanism in the CT connector when plug-in
Light sensor input 2 unit is detached
3) REF615 conf D: BIO0005 module (8BI+4BO)
X15 Alternative module BIO0007 (8BI+3HSO)
1)
Light sensor input 3 4) REF615 conf D: BIO0006 module (6BI+3BO)
Alternative module RTD0001 (6RTD+2mA) 3
REF615 45
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
46 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
L1
L2
L3
REF615
X130 X100
Positive +
Current 1
1 0,2/1A
U aux
Direction 2 Io 2
N -
3
X131 IRF
4
4 5
IL1
5
7 PO1
U1
8
6
X132 7
4 PO2
IL2
5
8
7 9
U2
8 10
X133 SO1
11
4 12
IL3
5 13
7 SO2
U3
8 14
16
PO3
17
P1 S1 15
19
S2
TCS1 18
P2
20
X110 22
PO4
1
BI 1 2) 21
2
23
3 TCS2 24
BI 2
4
5 X110
BI 3
6 2) 14
SO1
BI 4 16
7 15
17
8
BI 5 SO2
9
19
18
BI 6 20
10
SO3
11 22
BI 7
12 21
23
BI 8 SO4
13 24
X13
1)
Light sensor input 1
X14
1)
Light sensor input 2
1) Optional
X15 2) BIO0005 Module (8BI+4BO)
1)
Light sensor input 3 Alternative Module BIO0007 (8BI+3HSO)
Figure 14: Connection diagram for the G and L configurations with SIM0002 module
REF615 47
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
L1
L2
L3
REF615
X130 X100
Positive +
Current 1
1 0,2/1A
U aux
Direction 2 Io 2
N -
3
X131 IRF
L1/A
4
1 5
IL1
2
7 PO1
U1
8
6
X132 7
L2/B
1 PO2
IL2
2
8
7 9
U2
8 10
X133 SO1
L3/C
11
1 12
IL3
2 13
7 SO2
U3
8 14
16
PO3
17
P1 S1 15
19
S2
TCS1 18
P2
20
X110 22
PO4
1
BI 1 2) 21
2
23
3 TCS2 24
BI 2
4
5 X110
BI 3
6 2) 14
SO1
BI 4 16
7 15
17
8
BI 5 SO2
9
19
18
BI 6 20
10
SO3
11 22
BI 7
12 21
23
BI 8 SO4
13 24
X13
1)
Light sensor input 1
X14
1)
Light sensor input 2
1) Optional
X15 2) BIO0005 Module (8BI+4BO)
1)
Light sensor input 3 Alternative Module BIO0007 (8BI+3HSO)
Figure 15: Connection diagram for the G and L configurations with SIM0005 module
48 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 49
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
L1
L2
L3
A
n
N REF615
X130 X100
1 + 1
a BI 1 Uaux
2
-
2
da dn 3
BI 2 3
4 IRF
4
5
BI 3 5
6
PO1
7
BI 4
8 6
60 - 7
9 210V
U12B (for SECRSYN1)
10 N PO2
60 -
11 210V
U1 8
12 N 9
60 - 10
13 210V
U2 SO1
14 N
60 -
15 210V
11
U3 12
16 N 13
60 -
17 210V SO2
Uo
18 N
14
16
PO3
X120
Positive 17
Current 1 1/5A 2) 15
not in use
Direction 19
2 N TCS1 18
3 1/5A
not in use 20
4 N 22
P1 5 1/5A PO4
S1 IoB (for HREFPDIF1)
6 N 21
S2 23
P2 7 1/5A
IL1 TCS2 24
8 N
9 1/5A
IL2
10 N X110
11 1/5A
14
IL3 3)
12 N SO1
13 1/5A
16
Io 15
14 N
17
P1 S1
SO2
X110 19
P2 S2
18
1 20
BI 1 3)
2 SO3
22
3 21
BI 2
4 23
SO4
5
BI 3 24
P1 S1 6
P2 S2 BI 4
7
8
BI 5
9
BI 6
10
11
BI 7
12
BI 8
13
X13
1)
Light sensor input 1
X14
1) 1) Optional
Light sensor input 2 2) The IED features an automatic short-circuit
mechanism in the CT connector when plug-in
X15 unit is detached
1) 3) BIO0005 Module (8BI+4BO)
Light sensor input 3
Alternative Module BIO0007 (8BI+3HSO)
50 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
3.3.1 Applications
The standard configuration for non-directional overcurrent and directional earth-
fault protection is mainly intended for cable and overhead-line feeder applications
in isolated and resonant-earthed distribution networks. The configuration
also includes additional options for selecting earth-fault protection based on
admittance or wattmetric-based principles.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
REF615 51
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.3.2 Functions
Uo
Lockout relay
HMI
Time
Authorization
- Self-supervision
94/86 I ESC Clear
- Time synchronization: IEEE 1588 v2,
SNTP, IRIG-B
A
O R
L
U12 0. 0 kV
P 0.00 kW
Q 0.00 kVAr - User management
2× - Web HMI
IL2 0 A
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
Uo - I, Io, Uo
Object Ctrl 2) Ind 3)
3× 3× - Limit value supervision
Yo>→ Po>→ CB 1 - - Symmetrical components
21YN 32N
DC - -
OR Analog interface types 1)
ES - -
1)
Check availability of binary inputs/outputs
Current transformer 4
from technical documentation Voltage transformer 1
2)
Control and indication function for
primary object 1)
Conventional transformer inputs
3)
Status indication function for
primary object
3× 18×
Uo> MAP SOTF O→I
59G MAP SOTF 79
REMARKS
Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
function instances value function to be
Io/Uo defined when
ordering
52 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Non-directional overcurrent operate
2 Directional or intermittent earth-fault operate
3 Double (cross country) earth-fault or residual overvoltage operate
4 Negative sequence overcurrent or phase discontinuity operate
5 Thermal overload alarm
6 Breaker failure operate
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 –
9 Trip circuit supervision alarm
10 Arc protection operate
11 Autoreclose in progress
REF615 53
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 Uo
6 –
7 –
8 –
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
54 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 55
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
available for the disturbance recorder function are freely selectable as a part of
the disturbance recorder’s parameter settings.
The phase currents to the protection relay are fed from a current transformer. The
residual current to the protection relay is fed from either residually connected CTs,
an external core balance CT, neutral CT or calculated internally.
The residual voltage to the protection relay is fed from either the residually
connected VTs or an open delta connected VT.
The protection relay offers six different setting groups which can be set based
on individual needs. Each group can be activated or deactivated using the setting
group settings available in the protection relay.
Depending on the communication protocol the required function block needs to be
instantiated in the configuration.
PHHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC2_START
PHLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC1_START
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHxPTOC_OPERATE
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
56 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
NSPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
REF615 57
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
DEFLPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
DEFLPDEF2
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF2_START
RCA_CTL
DEFHPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFHPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O DEF_OPERATE
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
INTRPTEF1
BLOCK OPERATE INTRPTEF1_OPERATE
START INTRPTEF1_START
BLK_EF
WPWDE1
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE1_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE1_START
WPWDE2
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE2_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE2_START
WPWDE3
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE3_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE3_START
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O WPWDE_OPERATE
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
58 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
EFPADM1
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM1_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM1_START
EFPADM2
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM2_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM2_START
EFPADM3
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM3_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM3_START
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O EFPADM_OPERATE
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 59
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output is used to give a backup trip to the breaker
feeding upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to
the binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
B4 B4
B5 B5
B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
60 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 61
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
OR6 PHHPTOC2_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B1 O INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2 INIT_5 LOCKED
B3 INIT_6 PROT_CRD
B4 DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
B5 DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
B6 DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
CB_READY
OR6 INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O RECL_ON
EFPADM3_OPERATE B2 SYNC
B3
B4
B5
B6
OR6
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B5 OR
B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
ROVPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV3_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV3_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
62 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
General start and operate from all the functions are connected to minimum pulse
timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The output
from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs.
OR6
PHLPTOC1_START B1 O
PHHPTOC1_START B2
PHHPTOC2_START B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4
NSPTOC1_START B5
NSPTOC2_START B6
OR6
OR6
B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O B2
DEFLPDEF2_START B2 B3
DEFHPDEF1_START B3 B4
B4 B5 TPGAPC1
B5 B6
B6 IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START_PULSE
IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6 OR6
INTRPTEF1_START B1 O B1 O
EFHPTOC1_START B2 B2
PDNSPTOC1_START B3 B3
ROVPTOV1_START B4 B4
ROVPTOV2_START B5 B5
ROVPTOV3_START B6 B6
OR6
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions are
available at binary outputs X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. Both the trip logic functions are
provided with lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal
duration setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input has been
assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a
push button.
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
REF615 63
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
B1 O
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B2
WPWDE1_OPERATE B3
WPWDE2_OPERATE B4
WPWDE3_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
64 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 65
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
Figure 40: Circuit breaker control logic: Signals for the closing coil of circuit breaker
1
66 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 41: Circuit breaker control logic: Signals for the opening coil of circuit breaker
1
NOT
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT
AND
B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
B2
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
The configuration includes the logic for generating circuit breaker external closing
and opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
REF615 67
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
can generate low alarm or warning and high alarm or warning signals for the
measured current values.
CMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
CSMSQI1
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
RESVMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
68 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
REF615 69
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED1
OK
PHxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED2
OR6
OK
DEF_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
EFPADM_OPERATE B2 RESET
WPWDE_OPERATE B3
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
LED3
OR
OK
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED4
OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
70 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED9
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM ALARM
RESET
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
3.4.1 Applications
The standard configuration for non-directional overcurrent and directional earth-
fault protection is mainly intended for cable and overhead-line feeder applications
in isolated and resonant-earthed distribution networks. The configuration
also includes additional options for selecting earth-fault protection based on
admittance, wattmetric or harmonic-based principles.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
REF615 71
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.4.2 Functions
Uo
Lockout relay
HMI
Lockout relay
Time
Authorization
3I
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
6xRTD REMARKS
2xmA
Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
function instances value function to be
Io/Uo defined when
ordering
72 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Non-directional overcurrent operate
2 Directional/intermittent earth-fault operate
3 Double (cross country) earth-fault or residual overvoltage operate
4 Negative sequence overcurrent or phase discontinuity operate
5 Thermal overload alarm
Table continues on the next page
REF615 73
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
6 Breaker failure operate
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 Circuit breaker condition monitoring alarm
9 Trip circuit supervision alarm
10 Arc protection operate
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 Uo
6 –
7 –
8 –
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
74 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 75
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
76 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
PHIPTOC1
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING BLOCK OPERATE PHIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHIPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC2_START
PHLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC1_START
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHxPTOC_OPERATE
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second high stage of three-phase non-
directional overcurrent protection PHHPTOC2 is connected to the binary output
X110:SO1. This output can be used for sending a blocking signal to the relevant
overcurrent protection stage of the IED at the infeeding bay.
OR6
PHHPTOC2_START B1 O UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
REF615 77
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
NSPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Three stages are provided for directional earth-fault protection. According to the
IED's order code, the directional earth-fault protection method can be based on
conventional directional earth-fault DEFxPDEF only or alternatively used together
with admittance-based earth-fault protection EFPADM or wattmetric-based earth-
fault protection WPWDE or harmonics-based earth-fault protection HAEFPTOC1.
In addition, there is a dedicated protection stage INTRPTEF either for transient-
based earth-fault protection or for cable intermittent earth-fault protection in
compensated networks.
The binary input X110:BI2 is used for controlling directional earth-fault protection
block's relay characteristic angle (RCA: 0°, -90°) or operation mode (IoSinφ, IoCosφ)
change. The same input is also available for wattmetric protection.
78 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
DEFLPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF1_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
DEFLPDEF2
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF2_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
DEFHPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFHPDEF1_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O DEFxPDEF_OPERATE
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
INTRPTEF1
BLOCK OPERATE INTRPTEF1_OPERATE
START INTRPTEF1_START
BLK_EF
REF615 79
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
WPWDE1
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE1_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE1_START
WPWDE2
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE2_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE2_START
WPWDE3
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE3_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE3_START
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O WPWDE_OPERATE
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
EFPADM1
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM1_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM1_START
EFPADM2
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM2_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM2_START
EFPADM3
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM3_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM3_START
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O EFPADM_OPERATE
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
80 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
EFHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The output TRBU gives a backup trip to the breaker feeding
upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to the
binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4 B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5 B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3
WPWDE3_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
REF615 81
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
82 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
The circuit breaker availability for the autoreclosing sequence is expressed with the
CB_READY input in DARREC1. The signal, and other required signals, are connected
to the CB spring charged binary inputs in this configuration. The open command
from the autorecloser is connected directly to the binary output X100:PO3, whereas
the close command is connected directly to the binary output X100:PO1.
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
OR6 PHHPTOC2_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B1 O INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2 INIT_5 LOCKED
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3 INIT_6 PROT_CRD
B4 DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
B5 DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
B6 DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
OR6 X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
INC_SHOTP
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O INHIBIT_RECL
EFPADM3_OPERATE B2 RECL_ON
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3 SYNC
B4
B5
B6
OR6
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B5 OR
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 83
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
ROVPTOV1
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV1_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV1_START
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
ROVPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV3_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV3_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate from all the functions are connected to minimum pulse
timer TPGAPC for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The output
from TPGAPC is connected to binary outputs.
OR6 OR6 TPGAPC1
PHLPTOC1_START B1 O B1 O IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START_PULSE
PHHPTOC1_START B2 B2 IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
PHHPTOC2_START B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4 B4
NSPTOC1_START B5 B5
NSPTOC2_START B6 B6
OR6
OR6 OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_START B2 PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
DEFHPDEF1_START B3 PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2
EFPADM1_START B4 PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3
EFPADM2_START B5 PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFPADM3_START B6 NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_START B1 O
EFHPTOC1_START B2 DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
PDNSPTOC1_START B3 DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV1_START B4 DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV2_START B5 EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV3_START B6 EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
OR6
WPWDE1_START B1 O
WPWDE2_START B2 INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE3_START B3 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
B4 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
B5 ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
B6 ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
WPWDE1_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_OPERATE B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two
trip logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is
available at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are
provided with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal
duration setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, the binary input has
84 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
been assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset
with a push button. Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED
is ordered with high speed binary outputs options.
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
B1 O
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B2
WPWDE1_OPERATE B3
WPWDE2_OPERATE B4
WPWDE3_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 85
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
86 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included, TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. Both the functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
REF615 87
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm and circuit-breaker spring charging status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines whether the disconnector or breaker truck
is either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This output, together
with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-enable
88 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for circuit
breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
Connect the additional signals required for the application for closing
and opening of circuit breaker.
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
Figure 81: Circuit-breaker control logic: Signals for closing coil of circuit breaker
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 82: Circuit-breaker control logic: Signals for opening coil of circuit breaker
NOT AND6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
B2
B3
B4
NOT B5
B6
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
The configuration includes logic for generating circuit breaker external closing and
opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
REF615 89
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
CSMSQI1
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
90 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
RESVMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
REF615 91
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 1
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
X110 (BIO).X110-SO1
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
92 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED1
OK
PHxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED2
OR6
OK
DEF_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
EFPADM_OPERATE B2 RESET
WPWDE_OPERATE B3
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
LED3
OR
OK
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED4
OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
REF615 93
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
SSCBR1_ALARMS ALARM
RESET
LED9
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM ALARM
RESET
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
OR6
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O
EFPADM_OPERATE B2
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B3
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B5
WPWDE_OPERATE B6
Figure 97: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
94 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
3.5.1 Applications
The standard configuration for non-directional overcurrent and non-directional
earth-fault protection is mainly intended for cable and overhead-line feeder
applications in directly or resistance-earthed distribution networks.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
REF615 95
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.5.2 Functions
Lockout relay
HMI
Time
Authorization
- Self-supervision
94/86 I ESC Clear
- Time synchronization: IEEE 1588 v2,
SNTP, IRIG-B
A
O R
L
U12 0. 0 kV
P 0.00 kW
Q 0.00 kVAr - User management
2× - Web HMI
IL2 0 A
3I
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
O→I
79
REMARKS
Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
function instances value function to be
Io/Uo defined when
ordering
96 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Non-directional overcurrent operate
2 Non-directional earth-fault operate
3 Sensitive earth-fault operate
4 Negative sequence overcurrent or phase discontinuity operate
5 Thermal overload alarm
6 Breaker failure operate
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 –
9 Trip circuit supervision alarm
10 Arc protection operate
11 Autoreclose in progress
REF615 97
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 –
6 –
7 –
8 –
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
98 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 99
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
PHHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC2_START
PHLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC1_START
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHxPTOC_OPERATE
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
100 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
NSPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC1_START
NSPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Four stages are provided for non-directional earth-fault protection. One stage is
dedicated to sensitive earth-fault protection EFLPTOC2.
EFIPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFIPTOC1_START
EFHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
EFLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC1_START
OR6
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O EFxPTOC_OPERATE
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
EFLPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC2_START
REF615 101
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
PDNSPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE
START PDNSPTOC1_START
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output is used to give a backup trip to the breaker
feeding upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to
the binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
102 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 103
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_5 LOCKED
INIT_6 PROT_CRD
DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
CB_READY
INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
OR6 RECL_ON
SYNC
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
B5 OR
B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate from all the functions are connected to minimum pulse
timer TPGAPC for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The output
from TPGAPC is connected to the binary outputs.
OR6
PHLPTOC1_START B1 O
PHHPTOC1_START B2
PHHPTOC2_START B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4
NSPTOC1_START B5
NSPTOC2_START B6
OR6
OR6
B1 O
EFLPTOC1_START B1 O B2
EFLPTOC2_START B2 B3
EFIPTOC1_START B3 B4
EFHPTOC1_START B4 B5 TPGAPC1
PDNSPTOC1_START B5 B6
B6 IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START
IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE
OR6 OR6
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, the binary input X120:BI4 has
been assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset
with a push button.
104 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B5
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
REF615 105
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
RDRE1
PHLPTOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED
PHHPTOC1_START C2
PHHPTOC2_START C3
PHIPTOC1_START C4
NSPTOC1_START C5
NSPTOC2_START C6
EFLPTOC1_START C7
EFHPTOC1_START C8
EFIPTOC1_START C9
EFLPTOC2_START C10
C11
PDNSPTOC1_START C12
T1PTTR1_START C13
OR6 CCBRBRF1_TRRET C14
CCBRBRF1_TRBU C15
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O C16
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 C17
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 C18
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4 C19
B5 EFLPTOC2_OPERATE C20
B6 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE C21
INRPHAR1_BLK2H C22
T1PTTR1_OPERATE C23
C24
ARCSARC1_OPERATE C25
OR ARCSARC2_OPERATE C26
ARCSARC3_OPERATE C27
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O DARREC1_INPRO C28
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 DARREC1_CLOSE_CB C29
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL C30
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING C31
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED C32
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED C33
OR6 C34
C35
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O C36
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 C37
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3 C38
B4 C39
B5 C40
B6 C41
C42
C43
C44
C45
OR6 C46
C47
ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O C48
ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2 C49
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3 C50
B4 C51
B5 C52
B6 C53
C54
C55
C56
C57
C58
C59
C60
C61
C62
C63
C64
106 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
REF615 107
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
Figure 116: Circuit breaker control logic: Signal for closing of circuit breaker 1
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 117: Circuit breaker control logic: Signal for opening of circuit breaker 1
NOT
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT
AND
B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
B2
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
The configuration includes logic for generating circuit breaker external closing and
opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
Connect any additional signal applicable for the configuration for closing
and opening of circuit breaker in local or remote mode.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
108 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
the sequence current and the residual current measurement RESCMMXU1 measures
the residual current.
The measurements can be seen from the LHMI and they are available under the
measurement option in the menu selection. Based on the settings, function blocks
can generate low alarm or warning and high alarm or warning signals for the
measured current values.
CMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
CSMSQI1
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 4
REF615 109
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
LED1
OK
PHxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED2
OK
EFxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED3
OK
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED4
OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
110 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED9
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM ALARM
RESET
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
3.6.1 Applications
The standard configuration for non-directional overcurrent and non-directional
earth-fault protection is mainly intended for cable and overhead-line feeder
applications in directly or resistance earthed distribution networks.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
REF615 111
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.6.2 Functions
Lockout relay
HMI
Time
Authorization
3I
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
O→I
79
REMARKS
Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
function instances value function to be
Io/Uo defined when
ordering
112 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Non-directional overcurrent operate
2 Non-directional earth-fault operate
3 Sensitive earth-fault operate
4 Negative sequence overcurrent or phase discontinuity operate
Table continues on the next page
REF615 113
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
5 Thermal overload alarm
6 Breaker failure operate
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 Circuit breaker condition monitoring alarm
9 Trip circuit supervision alarm
10 Arc protection operate
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 –
6 –
7 –
8 –
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
114 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 115
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The protection relay offers six different setting groups which can be set based
on individual needs. Each group can be activated or deactivated using the setting
group settings available in the protection relay.
Depending on the communication protocol the required function block needs to be
instantiated in the configuration.
PHHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC2_START
PHLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC1_START
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHxPTOC_OPERATE
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second high stage of three-phase non-
directional overcurrent protection PHHPTOC2 is connected to the binary output
X110:SO1. This output can be used for sending a blocking signal to the relevant
overcurrent protection stage of the IED at the infeeding bay.
116 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
PHHPTOC2_START B1 O UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
NSPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
REF615 117
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
EFIPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFIPTOC1_START
EFHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
EFLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC1_START
OR6
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O EFxPTOC_OPERATE
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
EFLPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC2_START
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
118 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output gives a backup trip to the breaker feeding
upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to the
binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
Three protection S1...3 stages are included as an optional function. The protection
offers individual function blocks for three sensors that can be connected to the IED.
Each protection function block has two different operation modes, that is, with or
without the phase and residual current check.
The operate signals S1...3 are connected to both trip logic TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2.
If the IED has been ordered with high speed binary outputs, the individual operate
signals from S1...3 are connected to dedicated trip logic TRPPTRC3...5. The output
of TRPPTRC3...5 are available at high speed outputs X110:HSO1, X110:HSO2 and
X110:HSO3.
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 119
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate signals from all the functions are connected to minimum
pulse timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The
output from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs.
120 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
PHLPTOC1_START B1 O
PHHPTOC1_START B2
PHHPTOC2_START B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4
NSPTOC1_START B5
NSPTOC2_START B6
OR6
OR6
B1 O
EFLPTOC1_START B1 O B2
EFLPTOC2_START B2 B3
EFIPTOC1_START B3 B4
EFHPTOC1_START B4 B5 TPGAPC1
PDNSPTOC1_START B5 B6
B6 IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START
IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE
OR6 OR6
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary outputs X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input X120:BI4 has been
assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a
push button.
Other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
REF615 121
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B5
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
122 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
RDRE1
PHLPTOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED
PHHPTOC1_START C2
PHHPTOC2_START C3
PHIPTOC1_START C4
NSPTOC1_START C5
NSPTOC2_START C6
EFLPTOC1_START C7
EFHPTOC1_START C8
EFIPTOC1_START C9
EFLPTOC2_START C10
C11
OR6 PDNSPTOC1_START C12
T1PTTR1_START C13
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O CCBRBRF1_TRRET C14
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 CCBRBRF1_TRBU C15
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 C16
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4 C17
B5 C18
B6 X110_BI2_EXT_START_AUTORECLOSE C19
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE C20
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE C21
INRPHAR1_BLK2H C22
T1PTTR1_OPERATE C23
OR C24
ARCSARC1_OPERATE C25
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC2_OPERATE C26
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 ARCSARC3_OPERATE C27
DARREC1_INPRO C28
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB C29
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL C30
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING C31
OR6 X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED C32
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED C33
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O C34
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 C35
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3 C36
B4 C37
B5 C38
B6 C39
C40
C41
C42
C43
OR6 C44
C45
ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O C46
ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2 C47
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3 C48
B4 C49
B5 C50
B6 C51
C52
C53
C54
C55
C56
C57
C58
C59
C60
C61
C62
C63
C64
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
REF615 123
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. Both functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
124 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm and circuit breaker spring charging status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines if the disconnector or breaker truck is
definitely either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This output,
together with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-
REF615 125
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
enable signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for
circuit breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
NOT AND6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
B2
B3
B4
NOT B5
B6
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
The configuration includes logic for generating circuit breaker external closing and
opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
126 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
CSMSQI1
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
REF615 127
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_EXT_START_AUTORECLOSE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
128 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 1
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 4
UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
X110 (BIO).X110-SO1
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
REF615 129
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED1
OK
PHxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED2
OK
EFxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED3
OK
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED4
OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
130 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
SSCBR1_ALARMS ALARM
RESET
LED9
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM ALARM
RESET
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
OR
EFxPTOC_OPERATE B1 O
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Figure 168: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
REF615 131
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.7.1 Applications
The standard configuration for non-directional overcurrent and directional earth-
fault protection is mainly intended for cable and overhead-line feeder applications
in isolated and resonant-earthed distribution networks. The configuration
also includes additional options for selecting earth-fault protection based on
admittance or wattmetric-based principles.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
132 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
3.7.2 Functions
UL1UL2UL3
Uo
Lockout relay
HMI
Lockout relay
Time
Authorization
3I AND
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
3× 18×
Uo> MAP SOTF O→I
59G MAP SOTF 79
2xRTD REMARKS
1xmA
Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
function instances value function to be
Io/Uo defined when
ordering
REF615 133
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
1 Non-directional overcurrent protection operated
2 Directional earth-fault protection operated
Table continues on the next page
134 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
3 Double (cross country) earth-fault or residual overvoltage protection op-
erated
4 Negative sequence overcurrent or phase discontinuity protection operat-
ed
5 Thermal overload alarm
6 Circuit breaker failure protection backup protection operated
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 Circuit breaker condition monitoring alarm
9 Supervision alarm
10 Arc fault detected
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 Uo
6 U1
7 U2
8 U3
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
REF615 135
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
136 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 137
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
PHIPTOC1
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING BLOCK OPERATE PHIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHIPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC2_START
PHLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC1_START
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHxPTOC_OPERATE
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second high stage of three-phase non-
directional overcurrent protection PHHPTOC2 is connected to the binary output
X110:SO1. This output can be used for sending a blocking signal to the relevant
overcurrent protection stage of the IED at the infeeding bay.
OR6
PHHPTOC2_START B1 O UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
138 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
NSPTOC2
CCSPVC1_FAIL BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Three stages are provided for directional earth-fault protection. According to the
IED's order code, the directional earth-fault protection method can be based on
conventional directional earth-fault DEFxPDEF only or alternatively used together
with admittance-based earth-fault protection EFPADM or wattmetric-based earth-
fault protection WPWDE. In addition, there is a dedicated protection stage
INTRPTEF either for transient-based earth-fault protection or for cable intermittent
earth-fault protection in compensated networks.
The binary input X110:BI2 is intended for controlling directional earth-fault
protection blocks' relay characteristic angle ( RCA: 0°, -90°) or operation mode
(IoSinφ, IoCosφ) change. The same input is also available for wattmetric protection.
REF615 139
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
DEFLPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF1_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
DEFLPDEF2
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF2_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
DEFHPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFHPDEF1_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O DEFxPDEF_OPERATE
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
INTRPTEF1
BLOCK OPERATE INTRPTEF1_OPERATE
START INTRPTEF1_START
BLK_EF
140 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
WPWDE1
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE1_OPERATE
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL START WPWDE1_START
WPWDE2
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE2_OPERATE
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL START WPWDE2_START
WPWDE3
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE3_OPERATE
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL START WPWDE3_START
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O WPWDE_OPERATE
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
EFPADM1
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM1_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM1_START
EFPADM2
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM2_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM2_START
EFPADM3
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM3_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM3_START
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O EFPADM_OPERATE
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 141
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
EFHPTOC1
CCSPVC1_FAIL BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output gives a backup trip to the breaker feeding
upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to the
binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4 B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5 B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM3_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_OPERATE B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
142 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
The operate signals from ARCSARC1...3 are connected to both trip logic TRPPTRC1
and TRPPTRC2. If the IED has been ordered with high speed binary outputs, the
individual operate signals from ARCSARC1...3 are connected to dedicated trip logic
TRPPTRC3...5. The output of TRPPTRC3...5 are available at high speed outputs
X110:HSO1, X110:HSO2 and X110:HSO3.
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
REF615 143
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
OR6 PHHPTOC2_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B1 O INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2 INIT_5 LOCKED
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3 INIT_6 PROT_CRD
B4 DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
B5 DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
B6 DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
OR6 X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
INC_SHOTP
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O INHIBIT_RECL
EFPADM3_OPERATE B2 RECL_ON
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3 SYNC
B4
B5
B6
OR6
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B5 OR
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
144 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ROVPTOV1
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV1_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV1_START
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
ROVPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV3_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV3_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate from all the functions are connected to minimum pulse
timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The output
from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs.
OR6 OR6 TPGAPC1
PHLPTOC1_START B1 O B1 O IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START_PULSE
PHHPTOC1_START B2 B2 IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
PHHPTOC2_START B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4 B4
NSPTOC1_START B5 B5
NSPTOC2_START B6 B6
OR6 OR6
INTRPTEF1_START B1 O DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_START B2 DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_START B3 DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_START B4 ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_START B5 ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_START B6 ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
EFPADM1_START B1 O INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFPADM2_START B2 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_START B3 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
WPWDE1_START B4 ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_START B5 ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_START B6 ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
WPWDE1_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_OPERATE B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input X120:BI4 has been
assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a
push button.
REF615 145
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
WPWDE1_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_OPERATE B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B1 O
EFPADM1_OPERATE B2
EFPADM2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM3_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
146 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B1 O
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL B2
The fuse failure supervision function SEQSPVC1 detects failures in the voltage
measurement circuits. Failures, such as an open MCB, raise an alarm.
SEQSPVC1
BLOCK FUSEF_3PH SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED CB_CLOSED FUSEF_U SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U
DISCON_OPEN
X110_BI1_MCB_OPENED MINCB_OPEN
REF615 147
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. Both functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
148 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm and circuit-breaker spring charging status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines if the disconnector or breaker truck is
definitely either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This output,
together with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-
REF615 149
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
enable signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for
circuit breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
Connect the additional signals required for the application for closing
and opening of circuit breaker.
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
Figure 200: Circuit breaker control logic: Signals for closing coil of circuit breaker 1
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 201: Circuit breaker control logic: Signals for opening coil of circuit breaker 1
AND6
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED B3
B4
NOT B5
B6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
150 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
T1PTTR1_BLK_CLOSE B1 O CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The configuration includes the logic for generating circuit breaker external closing
and opening commands with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
REF615 151
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The frequency measurement FMMXU1 of the power system and the three-phase
power and energy measurement PEMMXU1 are available. Load profile record
LDPRLRC1 is included in the measurements sheet. LDPRLRC1 offers the ability to
observe the loading history of the corresponding feeder.
CMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
CSMSQI1
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
VSMSQI1
RESVMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
FMMXU1
PEMMXU1
RSTACM
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
152 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 1 OR
B1 O X110_BI1_MCB_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 1
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
REF615 153
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 1
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 4
UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
X110 (BIO).X110-SO1
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
154 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED1
OK
PHxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED2
OR6
OK
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
B2 RESET
B3
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
LED3
OR
OK
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED4
OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
REF615 155
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
SSCBR1_ALARMS ALARM
RESET
LED9
OR6
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM B1 O ALARM
CCSPVC1_ALARM B2 RESET
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH B3
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U B4
B5
B6
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
OR6
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B2
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B3
WPWDE_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B5
EFPADM_OPERATE B6
Figure 221: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
156 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
MDSOPT and different types of timers and control functions. These functions are
not included in application configuration but they can be added based on the
system requirements.
3.8.1 Applications
The standard configuration includes directional overcurrent and directional earth-
fault protection with phase voltage based measurement, undervoltage and
overvoltage protection and measurement function. The configuration is mainly
intended for cable and overhead-line feeder applications in directly or resistance
earthed distribution networks. The configuration also includes additional options
for selecting earth-fault protection based on admittance, wattmetric or harmonic-
based principles.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
REF615 157
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.8.2 Functions
UL1UL2UL3
Uo
- Self-supervision
U12 0. 0 kV
O R
L - Time synchronization: IEEE 1588 v2,
SNTP, IRIG-B
P 0.00 kW
Q 0.00 kVAr
2×
IL2 0 A
- User management
I2> I2/I1> 3Ith>F 3I>>> - Web HMI
46 46PD 49F 50P/51P I
AND
ESC Clear
3I
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
UL1UL2UL3 3× 3×
3U< U2> U1< 3U> O→I
27 47O- 47U+ 59 79
REMARKS
18× Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
MAP SOTF function instances value function to be
MAP SOTF Io/Uo defined when
2xRTD ordering
1xmA
158 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Overcurrent protection operated
2 Earth-fault protection operated
Table continues on the next page
REF615 159
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
3 Voltage protection operated
4 Negative sequence overcurrent or phase discontinuity protection operat-
ed
5 Thermal overload alarm
6 Circuit breaker failure protection backup protection operated
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 Circuit breaker condition monitoring alarm
9 Supervision alarm
10 Arc fault detected
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 Uo
6 U1
7 U2
8 U3
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
160 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 161
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
162 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
The protection relay offers six different setting groups which can be set based
on individual needs. Each group can be activated or deactivated using the setting
group settings available in the protection relay.
Depending on the communication protocol the required function block needs to be
instantiated in the configuration.
DPHHPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHHPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC2
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC2_START
NON_DIR
OR6
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O DPHxPDOC_OPERATE
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B2
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second low stage of three-phase
directional overcurrent protection DPHLPDOC2 is connected to the binary output
X110:SO1. This output can be used for sending a blocking signal to the relevant
overcurrent protection stage of the IED at the infeeding bay.
REF615 163
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6
DPHLPDOC2_START B1 O UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
NSPTOC2
CCSPVC1_FAIL BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Three stages are provided for directional earth-fault protection. According to the
IED's order code, the directional earth-fault protection method can be based on
conventional directional earth-fault DEFxPDEF only or alternatively used together
with admittance-based earth-fault protection EFPADM or wattmetric-based earth-
fault protection WPWDE or harmonics-based earth-fault protection HAEFPTOC.
A dedicated protection stage INTRPTEF is used either for transient-based earth-
fault protection or for cable intermittent earth-fault protection in compensated
networks.
The binary input X110:BI2 is intended for controlling directional earth-fault
protection blocks' relay characteristic angle ( RCA: 0°, -90°) or operation mode
(IoSinφ, IoCosφ) change. The same input is also available for wattmetric protection.
164 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
DEFLPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF1_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
DEFLPDEF2
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF2_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
DEFHPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFHPDEF1_START
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O DEFxPDEF_OPERATE
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
INTRPTEF1
BLOCK OPERATE INTRPTEF1_OPERATE
START INTRPTEF1_START
BLK_EF
REF615 165
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
WPWDE1
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE1_OPERATE
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL START WPWDE1_START
WPWDE2
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE2_OPERATE
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL START WPWDE2_START
WPWDE3
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE3_OPERATE
X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL RCA_CTL START WPWDE3_START
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O WPWDE_OPERATE
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
EFPADM1
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM1_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM1_START
EFPADM2
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM2_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM2_START
EFPADM3
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM3_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM3_START
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O EFPADM_OPERATE
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
166 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
EFHPTOC1
CCSPVC1_FAIL BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by a
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker-failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output is used to give a backup trip to the breaker
feeding upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to
the binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4 B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5 B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3
WPWDE3_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
REF615 167
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The operate signals from ARCSARC1...3 are connected to both trip logic TRPPTRC1
and TRPPTRC2. If the IED has been ordered with high speed binary outputs, the
individual operate signals from ARCSARC1...3 are connected to dedicated trip logic
TRPPTRC3...5. The output of TRPPTRC3...5 are available at high speed outputs
X110:HSO1, X110:HSO2 and X110:HSO3.
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
168 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
OR6 DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B1 O INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2 INIT_5 LOCKED
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3 INIT_6 PROT_CRD
B4 DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
B5 DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
B6 DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
OR6 INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O RECL_ON
EFPADM3_OPERATE B2 SYNC
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
OR6
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B5 OR
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 169
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
PHPTOV1
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV1_OPERATE
START PHPTOV1_START
PHPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV2_OPERATE
START PHPTOV2_START
PHPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV3_OPERATE
START PHPTOV3_START
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTOV_OPERATE
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
PHPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV1_OPERATE
START PHPTUV1_START
PHPTUV2
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV2_OPERATE
START PHPTUV2_START
PHPTUV3
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV3_OPERATE
START PHPTUV3_START
OR6
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTUV_OPERATE
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
170 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
ROVPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV3_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV3_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
NSPTOV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOV1_OPERATE
START NSPTOV1_START
PSPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PSPTUV1_OPERATE
START PSPTUV1_START
General start and operate from all the functions are connected to minimum pulse
timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The output
from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs
If a new protection function block to the configuration is added, check
the activation logic and add the connections.
REF615 171
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6 OR6
DPHLPDOC1_START B1 O B1 O
DPHLPDOC2_START B2 B2
DPHHPDOC1_START B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4 B4
NSPTOC1_START B5 B5
NSPTOC2_START B6 B6
TPGAPC1
IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START_PULSE
IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6 OR6 OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_START B2 DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2
DEFHPDEF1_START B3 DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
INTRPTEF1_START B4 NSPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFHPTOC1_START B5 NSPTOC2_OPERATE B5 B5
PDNSPTOC1_START B6 PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6 OR6
PHPTOV1_START B1 O DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_START B2 DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_START B3 DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_START B4 INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_START B5 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV1_START B6 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
PHPTUV2_START B1 O EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_START B2 EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV1_START B3 EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV2_START B4 ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV3_START B5 ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
B6 ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
EFPADM1_START B1 O PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O
EFPADM2_START B2 PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_START B3 PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
WPWDE1_START B4 NSPTOV1_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_START B5 PSPTUV1_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_START B6 PHPTOV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input X120:BI4 has been
assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a
push button.
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
172 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
REF615 173
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B2
WPWDE1_OPERATE B3
WPWDE2_OPERATE B4
WPWDE3_OPERATE B5
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B4
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
174 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O
EFPADM1_START B2
WPWDE1_START B3
B4 RDRE1
B5
B6 DPHLPDOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED
DPHLPDOC2_START C2
DPHHPDOC1_START C3
OR6 PHIPTOC1_START C4
NSPTOC1_START C5
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O OR6 NSPTOC2_START C6
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 C7
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B3 DEFLPDEF2_START B1 O C8
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B4 EFPADM2_START B2 C9
B5 WPWDE2_START B3 INTRPTEF1_START C10
B6 B4 EFHPTOC1_START C11
B5 PDNSPTOC1_START C12
B6 T1PTTR1_START C13
PHPTOV1_START C14
PHPTOV2_START C15
OR PHPTOV3_START C16
OR6 PSPTUV1_START C17
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOV1_START C18
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 DEFHPDEF1_START B1 O PHPTUV1_START C19
EFPADM3_START B2 PHPTUV2_START C20
WPWDE3_START B3 PHPTUV3_START C21
B4 ROVPTOV1_START C22
B5 ROVPTOV2_START C23
OR6 B6 ROVPTOV3_START C24
CCBRBRF1_TRRET C25
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O CCBRBRF1_TRBU C26
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2 OR C27
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3 C28
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4 B1 O C29
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5 B2 INTRPTEF1_OPERATE C30
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6 OR6 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE C31
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE C32
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O INRPHAR1_BLK2H C33
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2 T1PTTR1_OPERATE C34
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3 C35
OR6 B4 C36
B5 C37
B1 O B6 SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH C38
WPWDE1_OPERATE B2 SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U C39
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3 CCSPVC1_FAIL C40
WPWDE3_OPERATE B4 X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING C41
B5 OR6 X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED C42
B6 X120_BI3_CB_OPENED C43
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O C44
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2 C45
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3 ARCSARC1_OPERATE C46
B4 ARCSARC2_OPERATE C47
OR6 B5 ARCSARC3_OPERATE C48
B6 DARREC1_INPRO C49
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O C50
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2 C51
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3 C52
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4 C53
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5 C54
B6 OR6 C55
C56
ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O C57
ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2 C58
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3 C59
OR B4 C60
B5 C61
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B1 O B6 C62
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL B2 C63
C64
The fuse failure supervision SEQSPVC1 detects failures in the voltage measurement
circuits. Failures, such as an open MCB, raise an alarm.
SEQSPVC1
BLOCK FUSEF_3PH SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED CB_CLOSED FUSEF_U SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U
DISCON_OPEN
X110_BI1_MCB_OPENED MINCB_OPEN
REF615 175
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. Both functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
176 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm and the circuit breaker spring charging status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines if the disconnector or breaker truck is
definitely either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This output,
together with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-
REF615 177
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
enable signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for
circuit breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
Connect the additional signals required for the application for closing
and opening of circuit breaker.
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
AND6
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED B3
B4
NOT B5
B6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
178 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
T1PTTR1_BLK_CLOSE B1 O CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The configuration includes the logic for generating the circuit breaker external
closing and opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
REF615 179
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The frequency measurement FMMXU1 of the power system and the three-phase
power and energy measurement PEMMXU1 are available. Load profile record
LDPRLRC1 is included in the measurements sheet. LDPRLRC1 offers the ability to
observe the loading history of the corresponding feeder.
CMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
CSMSQI1
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
VSMSQI1
FMMXU1
PEMMXU1
RSTACM
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
180 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 1 OR
B1 O X110_BI1_MCB_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 1
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_RCA_CONTROL
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 1
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 4
REF615 181
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
X110 (BIO).X110-SO1
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
VOLTAGE_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO4
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
182 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED1
OR
OK
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED2
OR6
OK
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
EFPADM_OPERATE B2 RESET
WPWDE_OPERATE B3
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B4
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B5
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B6
LED3
OR6
OK
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B2 RESET
PHPTOV_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
LED4
OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
REF615 183
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
SSCBR1_ALARMS ALARM
RESET
LED9
OR6
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM B1 O ALARM
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH B2 RESET
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U B3
CCSPVC1_ALARM B4
B5
B6
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
184 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR TPGAPC2
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1 OC_OPERATE_PULSE
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2 EF_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B2
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFPADM_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B5
WPWDE_OPERATE B6
Figure 277: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
OR6 TPGAPC3
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1 VOLTAGE_OPERATE_PULSE
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2
PHPTUV_OPERATE B3
PHPTOV_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
3.9.1 Applications
The standard configuration includes directional overcurrent and directional earth-
fault protection, undervoltage and overvoltage protection, frequency protection
and measurement function. The configuration is mainly intended for cable
and overhead-line feeder applications in direct or resistance-earthed distributed
networks. The configuration also includes additional options for selecting earth-
fault protection based on admittance and wattmetric principles.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
REF615 185
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.9.2 Functions
Lockout relay
HMI
Lockout relay
Time
Authorization
U12 0. 0 kV
O R
L - Time synchronization: IEEE 1588 v2,
SNTP, IRIG-B
P 0.00 kW
Q 0.00 kVAr
2×
IL2 0 A
- User management
I2> I2/I1> 3Ith>F 3I>>> - Web HMI
46 46PD 49F 50P/51P I ESC Clear
AND
3I
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
primary object
1)
Combi sensor inputs with conventional
3× 3× Io input
3U< U2> U1< 3U> SYNC O→I
27 47O- 47U+ 59 25 79
UL1
REMARKS
18× Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
MAP SOTF function instances value function to be
MAP SOTF Io/Uo defined when
ordering
186 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Overcurrent protection operated
2 Earth-fault protection operated
3 Voltage protection operated
4 Negative sequence overcurrent or phase discontinuity protection operat-
ed
5 Thermal overload alarm
6 Circuit breaker failure protection backup protection operated
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
Table continues on the next page
REF615 187
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
8 Circuit breaker condition monitoring alarm
9 Supervision alarm
10 Arc fault detected
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 U1
6 U2
7 U3
8 –
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
188 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 189
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
190 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
Four overcurrent stages are offered for overcurrent and short-circuit protection.
Three of them include directional functionality DPHxPDOC.
PHIPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHIPTOC1_START
DPHHPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHHPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC2
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC2_START
NON_DIR
OR6
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O DPHxPDOC_OPERATE
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B2
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second low stage of three-phase
directional overcurrent protection DPHLPDOC2 is connected to the binary output
X110:SO1. This output can be used for sending a blocking signal to the relevant
overcurrent protection stage of the IED at the infeeding bay.
OR6
DPHLPDOC2_START B1 O UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
REF615 191
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
NSPTOC2
CCSPVC1_FAIL BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Three stages are provided for directional earth-fault protection. According to the
IED's order code, the directional earth-fault protection method can be based on
conventional directional earth-fault DEFxPDEF only or alternatively used together
with admittance-based earth-fault protection EFPADM or wattmetric-based earth-
fault protection WPWDE.
192 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
DEFLPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
DEFLPDEF2
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF2_START
RCA_CTL
DEFHPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFHPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O DEFxPDEF_OPERATE
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
WPWDE1
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE1_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE1_START
WPWDE2
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE2_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE2_START
WPWDE3
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE3_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE3_START
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O WPWDE_OPERATE
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 193
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
EFPADM1
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM1_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM1_START
EFPADM2
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM2_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM2_START
EFPADM3
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM3_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM3_START
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O EFPADM_OPERATE
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
194 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
T1PTTR1
BLK_OPR OPERATE T1PTTR1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START T1PTTR1_START
TEMP_AMB ALARM T1PTTR1_ALARM
BLK_CLOSE T1PTTR1_BLK_CLOSE
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output gives a backup trip to the breaker feeding
upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to the
binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5 B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3
WPWDE3_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B6
ARCSARC3_OPERATE
X110_BI1_CB_CLOSED
REF615 195
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
196 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
to the CB spring charged binary inputs in this configuration. The open command
from the autorecloser is connected directly to binary output X100:PO3, whereas the
close command is connected directly to binary output X100:PO1.
Set parameters for the DARREC1 function.
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
OR6 DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B1 O INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2 INIT_5 LOCKED
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3 INIT_6 PROT_CRD
B4 DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
B5 DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
B6 DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X110_BI2_CB_OPENED CB_POS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
OR6 INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O RECL_ON
EFPADM3_OPERATE B2 SYNC
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
OR6
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B5 OR
B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 197
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
PHPTOV1
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV1_OPERATE
START PHPTOV1_START
PHPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV2_OPERATE
START PHPTOV2_START
PHPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV3_OPERATE
START PHPTOV3_START
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTOV_OPERATE
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
PHPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV1_OPERATE
START PHPTUV1_START
PHPTUV2
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV2_OPERATE
START PHPTUV2_START
PHPTUV3
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV3_OPERATE
START PHPTUV3_START
OR6
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTUV_OPERATE
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
198 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
ROVPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV3_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV3_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
NSPTOV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOV1_OPERATE
START NSPTOV1_START
PSPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PSPTUV1_OPERATE
START PSPTUV1_START
General start and operate signals from all the functions are connected to minimum
pulse timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The
output from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs.
If a new protection function block to the configuration is added, check
the activation logic and also add the connections.
REF615 199
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6 OR6
DPHLPDOC1_START B1 O B1 O
DPHLPDOC2_START B2 B2
DPHHPDOC1_START B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4 B4
NSPTOC1_START B5 B5
NSPTOC2_START B6 B6
TPGAPC1
IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START_PULSE
IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6 OR6 OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_START B2 DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2
DEFHPDEF1_START B3 DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
B4 NSPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFHPTOC1_START B5 NSPTOC2_OPERATE B5 B5
PDNSPTOC1_START B6 PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6 OR6
PHPTOV1_START B1 O DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_START B2 DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_START B3 DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_START B4 B4
NSPTOV1_START B5 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV1_START B6 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
PHPTUV2_START B1 O EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_START B2 EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV1_START B3 EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV2_START B4 ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV3_START B5 ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
B6 ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
EFPADM1_START B1 O PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O
EFPADM2_START B2 PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_START B3 PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
WPWDE1_START B4 NSPTOV1_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_START B5 PSPTUV1_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_START B6 PHPTOV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input has been assigned
to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a push
button.
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
200 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 201
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B2
WPWDE1_OPERATE B3
WPWDE2_OPERATE B4
WPWDE3_OPERATE B5
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B4
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
202 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O
EFPADM1_START B2
B3
B4
B5
B6 RDRE1
OR6 DPHLPDOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED
DPHLPDOC2_START C2
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O DPHHPDOC1_START C3
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 OR6 PHIPTOC1_START C4
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B3 NSPTOC1_START C5
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B4 DEFLPDEF2_START B1 O NSPTOC2_START C6
B5 EFPADM2_START B2 C7
B6 WPWDE2_START B3 C8
B4 C9
B5 EFHPTOC1_START C10
B6 PDNSPTOC1_START C11
T1PTTR1_START C12
OR PHPTOV1_START C13
PHPTOV2_START C14
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTOV3_START C15
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 OR6 PSPTUV1_START C16
NSPTOV1_START C17
DEFHPDEF1_START B1 O PHPTUV1_START C18
EFPADM3_START B2 PHPTUV2_START C19
WPWDE3_START B3 PHPTUV3_START C20
B4 ROVPTOV1_START C21
OR6 B5 ROVPTOV2_START C22
B6 ROVPTOV3_START C23
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O CCBRBRF1_TRRET C24
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2 CCBRBRF1_TRBU C25
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3 OR C26
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4 C27
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5 B1 O C28
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6 B2 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE C29
OR6 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE C30
INRPHAR1_BLK2H C31
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O T1PTTR1_OPERATE C32
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2 C33
OR6 PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3 C34
B4 C35
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O B5 SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH C36
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2 B6 SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U C37
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3 CCSPVC1_FAIL C38
B4 X110_BI1_CB_CLOSED C39
B5 X110_BI2_CB_OPENED C40
B6 C41
OR6 ARCSARC1_OPERATE C42
ARCSARC2_OPERATE C43
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC3_OPERATE C44
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2 DARREC1_INPRO C45
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3 DARREC1_CLOSE_CB C46
B4 DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL C47
B5 C48
B6 C49
C50
OR6 C51
C52
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O C53
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2 C54
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3 C55
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4 OR6 C56
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5 C57
B6 ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O C58
ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2 C59
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3 C60
B4 C61
B5 C62
B6 C63
C64
The fuse failure supervision SEQSPVC1 detects failures in the voltage measurement
circuits.
SEQSPVC1
BLOCK FUSEF_3PH SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH
X110_BI1_CB_CLOSED CB_CLOSED FUSEF_U SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U
X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST DISCON_OPEN
MINCB_OPEN
REF615 203
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X110_BI2_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X110_BI1_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. Both functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
204 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X110_BI2_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated using the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and the earth-switch position status, status of the
trip logics, gas pressure alarm and circuit breaker spring charging status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines whether the disconnector or breaker truck
is definitely either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This output,
together with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-
REF615 205
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
enable signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for
circuit breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
Connect the additional signals required for the application for closing
and opening of circuit breaker.
CBXCBR1
X110_BI2_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X110_BI1_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
AND6
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED B3
B4
NOT B5
B6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
206 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
T1PTTR1_BLK_CLOSE B1 O CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The configuration includes the logic for generating circuit breaker external closing
and opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
REF615 207
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The frequency measurement FMMXU1 of the power system and the three-phase
power and energy measurement PEMMXU1 are available. Load profile record
LDPRLRC1 is included in the measurements sheet. LDPRLRC1 offers the ability to
observe the loading history of the corresponding feeder.
CMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
CSMSQI1
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
VSMSQI1
FMMXU1
PEMMXU1
RSTACM
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
208 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 1 OR
B1 O X110_BI1_CB_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 1
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_CB_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
REF615 209
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
X110 (BIO).X110-SO1
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
VOLTAGE_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO4
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
210 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED1
OR
OK
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED2
OR6
OK
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
EFPADM_OPERATE B2 RESET
WPWDE_OPERATE B3
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B4
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5
B6
LED3
OR6
OK
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B2 RESET
PHPTOV_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
LED4
OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
REF615 211
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
SSCBR1_ALARMS ALARM
RESET
LED9
OR6
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM B1 O ALARM
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH B2 RESET
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U B3
CCSPVCF1_ALARM B4
B5
B6
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
212 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR TPGAPC2
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1 OC_OPERATE_PULSE
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2 EF_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFPADM_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B4
WPWDE_OPERATE B5
B6
Figure 332: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
OR6 TPGAPC3
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1 VOLTAGE_OPERATE_PULSE
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2
PHPTUV_OPERATE B3
PHPTOV_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
3.10.1 Applications
The standard configuration for non-directional overcurrent and non-directional
earth-fault protection with phase voltage-based measurements, undervoltage and
overvoltage protection, frequency protection and measurement functions is mainly
intended for cable and overhead-line feeder applications in directly or resistance-
earthed distribution networks.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
REF615 213
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.10.2 Functions
UL1UL2UL3
Uo
Lockout relay
HMI
Lockout relay
Time
Authorization
AND
3I
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
primary object
UL1UL2UL3 3× 3× 3× 3×
3U< 3U> Uo> f>/f<, SYNC O→I
df/dt
27 59 59G 25 79
81
U12
Uo
REMARKS
18× Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
MAP SOTF function instances value function to be
MAP SOTF Io/Uo defined when
2xRTD ordering
1xmA
214 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Overcurrent protection operated
2 Earth-fault protection operated
Table continues on the next page
REF615 215
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
3 Combined protection operated indication
4 Synchronism or energizing check OK
5 Frequency protection
6 Circuit breaker failure protection backup protection operated
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 Circuit breaker condition monitoring alarm
9 Supervision alarm
10 Arc fault detected
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 Uo
6 U1
7 U2
8 U3
9 U1B
10 –
11 –
12 –
216 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 217
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
218 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
PHHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC2_START
PHLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC1_START
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHxPTOC_OPERATE
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second high stage of three-phase non-
directional overcurrent protection PHHPTOC2 is connected to the binary output
X110:SO1. This output can be used for sending a blocking signal to the relevant
overcurrent protection stage of the IED at the infeeding bay.
OR6
PHHPTOC2_START B1 O UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
REF615 219
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
NSPTOC2
CCSPVC1_FAIL BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Four stages are provided for non-directional earth-fault protection. One stage is
dedicated to sensitive earth-fault protection.
220 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
EFIPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFIPTOC1_START
EFHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
EFLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC1_START
EFLPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC2_START
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O EFxPTOC_OPERATE
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker-failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output is used to give a backup trip to the breaker
feeding upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to
the binary output X100:PO2.
REF615 221
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
222 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
REF615 223
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
connected to the CB spring charged binary inputs in this configuration. The open
command from the autorecloser is connected directly to binary output X100:PO3,
whereas the close command is connected directly to binary output X100:PO1.
Set the parameters for DARREC1 properly.
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_5 LOCKED
INIT_6 PROT_CRD
DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
OR6 RECL_ON
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK SYNC
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
B5 OR
B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B4
B5
B6
Three overvoltage and undervoltage protection stages PHPTOV and PHPTUV offer
protection against abnormal phase voltage conditions. A failure in the voltage
measuring circuit is detected by the fuse failure function and the activation is
connected to block undervoltage protection functions to avoid faulty tripping.
224 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
PHPTOV1
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV1_OPERATE
START PHPTOV1_START
PHPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV2_OPERATE
START PHPTOV2_START
PHPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV3_OPERATE
START PHPTOV3_START
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTOV_OPERATE
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
PHPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV1_OPERATE
START PHPTUV1_START
PHPTUV2
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV2_OPERATE
START PHPTUV2_START
PHPTUV3
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV3_OPERATE
START PHPTUV3_START
OR6
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTUV_OPERATE
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 225
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
ROVPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV3_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV3_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
226 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
FRPFRQ1
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ1_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ1_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
FRPFRQ2
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ2_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ2_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
FRPFRQ3
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ3_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ3_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O FREQUENCY_OPERATE
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate signals from all the functions are connected to minimum
pulse timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The
output from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs.
REF615 227
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6 OR6
PHLPTOC1_START B1 O B1 O
PHHPTOC1_START B2 B2
PHHPTOC2_START B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4 B4
NSPTOC1_START B5 B5
NSPTOC2_START B6 B6
TPGAPC1
IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START_PULSE
IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6
EFLPTOC1_START B1 O
EFLPTOC2_START B2
EFHPTOC1_START B3
EFIPTOC1_START B4 OR6 OR6
PDNSPTOC1_START B5
B6 PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_START B1 O
PHPTOV2_START B2
PHPTOV3_START B3 OR6
PHPTUV1_START B4
PHPTUV2_START B5 PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_START B6 PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B4
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
ROVPTOV1_START B1 O
ROVPTOV2_START B2
ROVPTOV3_START B3 OR6
FRPFRQ1_START B4
FRPFRQ2_START B5 EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ3_START B6 EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B2
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B4
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B4
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B5
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input X120:BI4 has been
assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a
push button.
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
228 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B4
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
REF615 229
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B4
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
230 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHHPTOC2_OPERATE B3
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4 RDRE1
B5
B6 PHLPTOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED
OR PHHPTOC1_START C2
PHHPTOC2_START C3
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHIPTOC1_START C4
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 NSPTOC1_START C5
NSPTOC2_START C6
OR6 EFLPTOC1_START C7
EFLPTOC2_START C8
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O EFHPTOC1_START C9
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B2 EFIPTOC1_START C10
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 PDNSPTOC1_START C11
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B4 PHPTOV1_START C12
B5 PHPTOV2_START C13
B6 PHPTOV3_START C14
PHPTUV1_START C15
PHPTUV2_START C16
PHPTUV3_START C17
ROVPTOV1_START C18
OR6 ROVPTOV2_START C19
ROVPTOV3_START C20
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O FRPFRQ1_START C21
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2 FRPFRQ2_START C22
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3 FRPFRQ3_START C23
B4 CCBRBRF1_TRRET C24
B5 CCBRBRF1_TRBU C25
B6 C26
C27
C28
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE C29
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE C30
OR6 INRPHAR1_BLK2H C31
C32
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O C33
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2 C34
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3 C35
B4 SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH C36
B5 SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U C37
B6 CCSPVC1_FAIL C38
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING C39
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED C40
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED C41
SECRSYN1_SYNC_INPRO C42
OR6 SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK C43
SECRSYN1_CL_FAIL_AL C44
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O SECRSYN1_CMD_FAIL_AL C45
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2 C46
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3 ARCSARC1_OPERATE C47
B4 ARCSARC2_OPERATE C48
B5 ARCSARC3_OPERATE C49
B6 DARREC1_INPRO C50
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB C51
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL C52
C53
C54
OR6 C55
C56
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O C57
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2 C58
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3 C59
B4 C60
B5 C61
B6 C62
C63
C64
OR6
ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O
ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3
B4
B5
B6
The fuse failure supervision SEQSPVC1 detects failures in the voltage measurement
circuits. Failures, such as an open MCB, raise an alarm.
SEQSPVC1
BLOCK FUSEF_3PH SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED CB_CLOSED FUSEF_U SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U
DISCON_OPEN
X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN MINCB_OPEN
REF615 231
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. Both functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
232 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
OR
X110_BI2_LINE_VT_MCB_OPEN B1 O BLOCK_SECRSYN1
X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN B2
Two types of disconnector and earthing switch function blocks are available.
DCSXSWI1...3 and ESSXSWI1...2 are status only type, and DCXSWI1...2 and ESXSWI1
are controllable type. By default, the status only blocks are connected in standard
REF615 233
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
configuration. The disconnector ( CB truck) and line side earthing switch status
information is connected to DCSXSWI1 and ESSXSI1.
DCSXSWI1
X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST POSOPEN OPENPOS
X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS DCSXSWI1_OKPOS
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm, circuit-breaker spring charging and synchronizing ok
status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines if the disconnector or breaker truck is
definitely either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This, together
with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-enable
signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for circuit
breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
Connect the additional signals required for the application for closing
and opening of circuit breaker.
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
234 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
AND6
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK B2
B3
B4
B5
NOT B6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
AND
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS B1 O
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
The configuration includes the logic for generating circuit breaker external closing
and opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
REF615 235
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
sequence current and the residual current measurement RESCMMXU1 measures the
residual current.
The three-phase bus side phase voltage and single phase line side phase voltage
inputs to the IED are measured by three-phase voltage measurement VMMXU1 and
VMMXU2. The voltage input is connected to the X130 card in the back panel. The
sequence voltage measurement VSMSQI1 measures the sequence voltage and the
residual voltage measurement RESVMMXU1 measures the residual voltage.
The measurements can be seen from the LHMI and they are available under the
measurement option in the menu selection. Based on the settings, function blocks
can generate low alarm or warning and high alarm or warning signals for the
measured current values.
The frequency measurement FMMXU1 of the power system and the three-phase
power and energy measurement PEMMXU1 are available. Load profile record
LDPRLRC1 is included in the measurements sheet. LDPRLRC1 offers the ability to
observe the loading history of the corresponding feeder.
CMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
CSMSQI1
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
VSMSQI1
RESVMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
236 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
VMMXU2
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
FMMXU1
PEMMXU1
RSTACM
Figure 376: Other measurement: Three phase power and energy measurement
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
REF615 237
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 1 OR
B1 O X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 1
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_LINE_VT_MCB_OPEN
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 1
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 4
238 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
X110 (BIO).X110-SO1
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
VOLTAGE_AND_FREQ_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO4
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
REF615 239
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED1
OK
PHxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED2
OR
OK
EFxPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED3
OR6
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
PHPTOV_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
LED4
AND
OK
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B1 O ALARM
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK B2 RESET
LED5
OK
FREQUENCY_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
240 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
SSCBR1_ALARMS ALARM
RESET
LED9
OR6
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM B1 O ALARM
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH B2 RESET
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U B3
CCSPVC1_ALARM B4
B5
B6
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
REF615 241
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TPGAPC2
PHxPTOC_OPERATE IN1 OUT1 OC_OPERATE_PULSE
IN2 OUT2 EF_OPERATE_PULSE
OR
EFxPTOC_OPERATE B1 O
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B2
Figure 384: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
OR6 TPGAPC3
PHPTOV_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1 VOLTAGE_AND_FREQ_OPERATE_PULSE
PHPTUV_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2
FREQUENCY_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 385: Timer logic for voltage and frequency operate pulse
3.11.1 Applications
The standard configuration for directional overcurrent and directional earth-fault
protection with phase voltage-based measurements, undervoltage and overvoltage
protection, frequency protection and measurement functions is mainly intended
for cable and overhead-line feeder applications in isolated or resonant-earthed
distribution networks. The configuration also includes additional options for
selecting earth-fault protection based on admittance, wattmetric or harmonic-
based principles.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
242 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
3.11.2 Functions
UL1UL2UL3
Uo
Lockout relay
HMI
Lockout relay
Time
Authorization
AND
3I
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
3× 3×
Uo> f>/f<, SYNC O→I PQM3I PQM3U PQMU
UL1UL2UL3 59G
df/dt
25 79 PQM3I PQM3V PQMV
81
U12
PQUUB
PQVUB
18×
MAP SOTF
MAP SOTF
2xRTD REMARKS
1xmA
Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
function instances value function to be
Io/Uo defined when
ordering
REF615 243
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
1 Overcurrent protection operate
2 Earth-fault protection operate
Table continues on the next page
244 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
3 Combined protection operated indication
4 Synchronism or energizing check OK
5 Thermal overload alarm
6 Circuit breaker failure protection backup protection operated
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 Circuit breaker condition monitoring
9 Circuit supervision alarm
10 Arc fault detected
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 Uo
6 U1
7 U2
8 U3
9 U1B
10 –
11 –
12 –
REF615 245
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
246 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 247
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The protection relay offers six different setting groups which can be set based
on individual needs. Each group can be activated or deactivated using the setting
group settings available in the protection relay.
Depending on the communication protocol the required function block needs to be
instantiated in the configuration.
DPHHPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHHPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC2
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC2_START
NON_DIR
OR6
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O DPHxPDOC_OPERATE
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B2
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second low stage of three-phase
directional overcurrent protection DPHLPDOC2 is connected to the binary output
X110:SO1. This output can be used for sending a blocking signal to the relevant
overcurrent protection stage of the IED at the infeeding bay.
248 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
DPHLPDOC2_START B1 O UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
NSPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Three stages are provided for directional earth-fault protection. According to the
IED's order code, the directional earth-fault protection method can be based on
conventional directional earth-fault DEFxPDEF only or alternatively used together
with admittance-based earth-fault protection EFPADM, wattmetric-based earth-
fault protection WPWDE or harmonics-based earth-fault protection HAEFPTOC.
In addition, there is a dedicated protection stage INTRPTEF either for transient-
based earth-fault protection or for cable intermittent earth-fault protection in
compensated networks.
REF615 249
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
DEFLPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
DEFLPDEF2
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF2_START
RCA_CTL
DEFHPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFHPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O DEFxPDEF_OPERATE
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
INTRPTEF1
BLOCK OPERATE INTRPTEF1_OPERATE
START INTRPTEF1_START
BLK_EF
250 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
WPWDE1
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE1_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE1_START
WPWDE2
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE2_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE2_START
WPWDE3
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE3_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE3_START
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O WPWDE_OPERATE
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
EFPADM1
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM1_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM1_START
EFPADM2
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM2_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM2_START
EFPADM3
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM3_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM3_START
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O EFPADM_OPERATE
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 251
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
EFHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output is used to give a backup trip to the breaker
feeding upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to
the binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4 B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5 B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3
WPWDE3_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
252 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
REF615 253
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The circuit breaker availability for the autoreclosing sequence is expressed with the
CB_READY input in DARREC1. The signal, and other required signals, are connected
to the CB spring charged binary inputs in this configuration. The open command
from the autorecloser is connected directly to binary output X100:PO3, whereas the
close command is connected directly to binary output X100:PO1.
Set the parameters for DARREC1 properly.
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
OR6 DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B1 O INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2 INIT_5 LOCKED
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3 INIT_6 PROT_CRD
B4 DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
B5 DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
B6 DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
OR6 INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O RECL_ON
EFPADM3_OPERATE B2 SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK SYNC
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
OR6
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B5 OR
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
254 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
PHPTOV1
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV1_OPERATE
START PHPTOV1_START
PHPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV2_OPERATE
START PHPTOV2_START
PHPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV3_OPERATE
START PHPTOV3_START
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTOV_OPERATE
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
PHPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV1_OPERATE
START PHPTUV1_START
PHPTUV2
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV2_OPERATE
START PHPTUV2_START
PHPTUV3
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV3_OPERATE
START PHPTUV3_START
OR6
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTUV_OPERATE
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 255
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
ROVPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV3_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV3_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
NSPTOV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOV1_OPERATE
START NSPTOV1_START
PSPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PSPTUV1_OPERATE
START PSPTUV1_START
256 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
FRPFRQ1
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ1_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ1_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
FRPFRQ2
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ2_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ2_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
FRPFRQ3
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ3_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ3_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O FREQUENCY_OPERATE
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate signals from all the functions are connected to minimum
pulse timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The
output from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs.
REF615 257
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6 OR6
DPHLPDOC1_START B1 O B1 O
DPHLPDOC2_START B2 B2
DPHHPDOC1_START B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4 B4
NSPTOC1_START B5 B5
NSPTOC2_START B6 B6
TPGAPC1
IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START_PULSE
IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6 OR6 OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_START B2 DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2
DEFHPDEF1_START B3 DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
INTRPTEF1_START B4 NSPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFHPTOC1_START B5 NSPTOC2_OPERATE B5 B5
PDNSPTOC1_START B6 PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6 OR6
PHPTOV1_START B1 O DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_START B2 DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_START B3 DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_START B4 INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_START B5 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV1_START B6 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
PHPTUV2_START B1 O EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_START B2 EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV1_START B3 EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV2_START B4 ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV3_START B5 ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
B6 ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
EFPADM1_START B1 O PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O
EFPADM2_START B2 PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_START B3 PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
WPWDE1_START B4 NSPTOV1_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_START B5 PSPTUV1_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_START B6 PHPTOV1_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
FRPFRQ1_START B1 O PHPTOV2_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_START B2 PHPTOV3_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_START B3 ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B3
B4 ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B4
B5 ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B5
B6 B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B4
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B5
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input X120:BI4 has been
assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a
push button.
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
258 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B3
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B4
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
REF615 259
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B2
WPWDE1_OPERATE B3
WPWDE2_OPERATE B4
WPWDE3_OPERATE B5
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B4
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B4
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B5
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
260 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6 RDRE1
DPHLPDOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED
DPHLPDOC2_START C2
DPHHPDOC1_START C3
OR6 PHIPTOC1_START C4
NSPTOC1_START C5
DEFLPDEF2_START B1 O NSPTOC2_START C6
OR6 B2 C7
B3 C8
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B4 C9
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 B5 INTRPTEF1_START C10
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B6 EFHPTOC1_START C11
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B4 PDNSPTOC1_START C12
B5 T1PTTR1_START C13
B6 PHPTOV1_START C14
OR6 PHPTOV2_START C15
PHPTOV3_START C16
DEFHPDEF1_START B1 O PSPTUV1_START C17
B2 NSPTOV1_START C18
OR B3 PHPTUV1_START C19
B4 PHPTUV2_START C20
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B5 PHPTUV3_START C21
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 B6 ROVPTOV1_START C22
ROVPTOV2_START C23
ROVPTOV3_START C24
CCBRBRF1_TRRET C25
CCBRBRF1_TRBU C26
OR6 OR C27
C28
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O C29
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2 B2 INTRPTEF1_OPERATE C30
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3 OR6 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE C31
B4 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE C32
B5 PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O INRPHAR1_BLK2H C33
B6 PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2 T1PTTR1_OPERATE C34
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3 C35
B4 C36
B5 C37
B6 SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH C38
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U C39
CCSPVC1_FAIL C40
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING C41
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED C42
OR6 X120_BI3_CB_OPENED C43
C44
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O C45
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2 ARCSARC1_OPERATE C46
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3 ARCSARC2_OPERATE C47
B4 ARCSARC3_OPERATE C48
B5 DARREC1_INPRO C49
B6 FRPFRQ1_START C50
OR6 FRPFRQ2_START C51
FRPFRQ3_START C52
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O C53
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2 SECRSYN1_SYNC_INPRO C54
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3 OR6 SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK C55
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4 SECRSYN1_CL_FAIL_AL C56
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5 ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O SECRSYN1_CMD_FAIL_AL C57
B6 ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2 C58
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3 C59
B4 C60
B5 C61
B6 C62
OR C63
C64
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B1 O
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL B2
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The fuse failure supervision SEQSPVC1 detects failures in the voltage measurement
circuits. Failures, such as an open MCB, raise an alarm.
SEQSPVC1
BLOCK FUSEF_3PH SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED CB_CLOSED FUSEF_U SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U
DISCON_OPEN
X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN MINCB_OPEN
REF615 261
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. The functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
262 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
OR
X110_BI2_LINE_VT_MCB_OPEN B1 O BLOCK_SECRSYN1
X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN B2
Two types of disconnector and earthing switch function blocks are available.
DCSXSWI1...3 and ESSXSWI1...2 are status only type, and DCXSWI1...2 and ESXSWI1
are controllable type. By default, the status only blocks are connected in standard
REF615 263
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
configuration. The disconnector ( CB truck) and line side earthing switch status
information is connected to DCSXSWI1 and ESSXSI1.
DCSXSWI1
X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST POSOPEN OPENPOS
X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS DCSXSWI1_OKPOS
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm, circuit-breaker spring charging and synchronizing ok
status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines if the disconnector or breaker truck is
definitely either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This, together
with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-enable
signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for circuit
breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
264 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
AND6
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK B2
B3
NOT B4
B5
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT B6
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
AND
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS B1 O
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
OR6
T1PTTR1_BLK_CLOSE B1 O CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The configuration includes logic for generating circuit breaker external closing and
opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
REF615 265
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
CSMSQI1
266 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
VSMSQI1
RESVMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU2
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
FMMXU1
PEMMXU1
RSTACM
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
REF615 267
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 1 OR
B1 O X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 1
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_LINE_VT_MCB_OPEN
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 1
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 4
268 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
X110 (BIO).X110-SO1
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
VOLTAGE_AND_FREQ_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO4
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
REF615 269
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED1
OR
OK
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED2
OR6
OK
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
B2 RESET
B3
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B4
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B5
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B6
LED3
OR6 OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RESET
PHPTOV_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV_OPERATE B4
FREQUENCY_OPERATE B5
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B6
PSPTUV1_OPERATE
LED4
AND
OK
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B1 O ALARM
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
270 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
SSCBR1_ALARMS ALARM
RESET
LED9
OR6
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM B1 O ALARM
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH B2 RESET
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U B3
CCSPVC1_ALARM B4
B5
B6
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
REF615 271
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR TPGAPC2
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1 OC_OPERATE_PULSE
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2 EF_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B2
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFPADM_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B5
WPWDE_OPERATE B6
Figure 445: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
OR6 TPGAPC3
PHPTUV_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1 VOLTAGE_AND_FREQ_OPERATE_PULSE
PHPTOV_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2
FREQUENCY_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5
B6
Figure 446: Timer logic for voltage and frequency operate pulse
3.12.1 Applications
The standard configuration for directional overcurrent and directional earth-fault
protection with phase voltage-based measurements, high-impendance restricted
earth-fault protection, undervoltage and overvoltage protection, frequency
protection and measurement functions is mainly intended for cable and overhead-
line feeder applications in isolated or resonant-earthed distribution networks. The
configuration also includes additional options for selecting earth-fault protection
based on admittance, wattmetric or harmonic-based principles.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
272 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
3.12.2 Functions
UL1UL2UL3
Uo
Lockout relay
HMI
Lockout relay
Time
Authorization
U12 0. 0 kV
O R
L - Time synchronization: IEEE 1588 v2,
SNTP, IRIG-B
P 0.00 kW
Q 0.00 kVAr
2×
IL2 0 A
- User management
I2> 3Ith>F 3I>>> - Web HMI
46 49F 50P/51P I ESC Clear
AND
3I
O R
L
OR
3× 3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF
primary object
1)
Conventional transformer inputs
2× 2× 2× 3×
3U< 3U> Uo> f>/f<, SYNC O→I PQM3I PQM3U PQMU
df/dt
27 59 59G 25 79 PQM3I PQM3V PQMV
81
U12
PQUUB
PQVUB
18×
FLOC MAP SOTF
21FL MAP SOTF
REMARKS
Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
function instances value function to be
Io/Uo defined when
ordering
REF615 273
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
1 Overcurrent protection operate
2 Earth-fault protection operate
Table continues on the next page
274 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
3 Combined protection operation indication
4 Synchronism or energizing check Ok
5 Frequency protection operated
6 Circuit breaker failure protection operated
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 High impedance restricted earth-fault protection operated
9 Circuit breaker condition monitoring or supervision alarm
10 Arc fault detected
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 IoB
6 Uo
7 U1
8 U2
9 U3
10 U1B
11 –
12 –
REF615 275
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
276 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 277
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
Five overcurrent stages are offered for overcurrent and short-circuit protection.
Two of them include directional functionality DPHxPDOC. Three-phase non-
directional overcurrent protection, instantaneous stage, PHIPTOC1 can be blocked
by energizing the binary input X130: BI1.
PHIPTOC1
X130_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING BLOCK OPERATE PHIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHIPTOC1_START
PHHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC1_START
PHLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC1_START
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHxPTOC_OPERATE
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
DPHHPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHHPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
OR
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O DPHxPDOC_OPERATE
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B2
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
278 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
NSPTOC2
CCSPVC1_FAIL BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Six stages are provided for earth-fault protection. Two stages are dedicated
for directional earth-fault protection. Apart from these earth-fault protection
functions, configuration also includes a dedicated high impedance restricted earth-
fault protection function.
REF615 279
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
EFIPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFIPTOC1_START
EFHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
EFLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC1_START
EFLPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC2_START
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O EFxPTOC_OPERATE
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
DEFHPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFHPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
DEFLPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
OR
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O DEFxPDEF_OPERATE
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
HREFPDIF1
BLOCK OPERATE HREFPDIF1_OPERATE
START HREFPDIF1_START
280 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker-failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output is used to give a backup trip to the breaker
feeding upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to
the binary output X100:PO2.
REF615 281
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
T1PTTR1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B5
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B6
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
HREFPDIF1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X130_BI2_CB_CLOSED
282 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X130_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X130_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X130_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
REF615 283
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The circuit breaker availability for the autoreclosure sequence is expressed with the
CB_READY input in DARREC1. The signal, and other required signals, are connected
to the CB spring charged binary inputs in this configuration. The open command
from the autorecloser is connected directly to binary output X100:PO3, whereas the
close command is connected directly to binary output X100:PO1.
Set the parameters for DARREC1 properly.
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
INIT_5 LOCKED
INIT_6 PROT_CRD
DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X130_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
OR6 RECL_ON
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK SYNC
T1PTTR1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B5 OR
B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
Two overvoltage and undervoltage protection stages PHPTOV and PHPTUV offer
protection against abnormal phase voltage conditions. A failure in the voltage
measuring circuit is detected by the fuse failure function and the activation is
connected to block undervoltage protection functions to avoid faulty tripping.
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
INIT_5 LOCKED
INIT_6 PROT_CRD
DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X130_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
OR6 RECL_ON
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK SYNC
T1PTTR1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B5 OR
B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
284 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
PHPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV1_OPERATE
START PHPTUV1_START
PHPTUV2
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV2_OPERATE
START PHPTUV2_START
OR
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTUV_OPERATE
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 285
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
FRPFRQ1
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ1_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ1_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
FRPFRQ2
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ2_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ2_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
FRPFRQ3
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ3_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ3_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O FREQUENCY_OPERATE
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate signals from all the functions are connected to minimum
pulse timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The
output from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs
286 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
EFLPTOC1_START B1 O
EFLPTOC2_START B2
EFHPTOC1_START B3
EFIPTOC1_START B4 OR6 OR6
DEFHPDEF1_START B5
DEFLPDEF1_START B6 PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
T1PTTR1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_START B1 O
PHPTOV2_START B2
PHPTUV1_START B3 OR6
PHPTUV2_START B4
ROVPTOV1_START B5 PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
ROVPTOV2_START B6 PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B6
OR6
FRPFRQ1_START B1 O
FRPFRQ2_START B2
FRPFRQ3_START B3 OR6
HREFPDIF1_START B4
NSPTOC1_START B5 EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC2_START B6 EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B2
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B4
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B5
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B6
OR6
HREFPDIF1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B4
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B5
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input X130:BI4 has been
assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a
push button.
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
REF615 287
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
B6 B6
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B4
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
T1PTTR1_OPERATE B3
HREFPDIF1_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B6
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
X130_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
288 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
B6 B6
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B4
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B5
HREFPDIF1_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B6
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B4
T1PTTR1_OPERATE B5
B6
X130_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
REF615 289
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B3
B4 RDRE1
B5
B6 PHLPTOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED
PHHPTOC1_START C2
PHIPTOC1_START C3
DPHLPDOC1_START C4
DPHHPDOC1_START C5
OR NSPTOC1_START C6
NSPTOC2_START C7
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O EFLPTOC1_START C8
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 EFLPTOC2_START C9
EFHPTOC1_START C10
OR EFIPTOC1_START C11
DEFLPDEF1_START C12
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O DEFHPDEF1_START C13
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 T1PTTR1_START C14
PHPTOV1_START C15
OR6 PHPTOV2_START C16
PHPTUV1_START C17
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTUV2_START C18
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B2 ROVPTOV1_START C19
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 ROVPTOV2_START C20
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B4 FRPFRQ1_START C21
B5 FRPFRQ2_START C22
B6 FRPFRQ3_START C23
OR HREFPDIF1_START C24
CCBRBRF1_TRRET C25
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O CCBRBRF1_TRBU C26
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B2 C27
C28
OR C29
C30
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O C31
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2 T1PTTR1_OPERATE C32
INRPHAR1_BLK2H C33
C34
C35
C36
OR C37
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH C38
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U C39
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2 CCSPVC1_FAIL C40
X130_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING C41
X130_BI2_CB_CLOSED C42
X130_BI3_CB_OPENED C43
SECRSYN1_SYNC_INPRO C44
OR SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK C45
SECRSYN1_CL_FAIL_AL C46
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O SECRSYN1_CMD_FAIL_AL C47
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2 C48
ARCSARC1_OPERATE C49
ARCSARC2_OPERATE C50
ARCSARC3_OPERATE C51
DARREC1_INPRO C52
OR6 DARREC1_CLOSE_CB C53
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL C54
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O C55
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2 C56
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3 C57
B4 C58
B5 C59
B6 C60
C61
C62
C63
C64
OR6
ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O
ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3
B4
B5
B6
The fuse failure supervision SEQSPVC1 detects failures in the voltage measurement
circuits at bus side. Failures, such as an open MCB, raise an alarm.
SEQSPVC1
BLOCK FUSEF_3PH SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED CB_CLOSED FUSEF_U SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U
DISCON_OPEN
X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN MINCB_OPEN
290 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X130_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X130_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. Both functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
REF615 291
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X130_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
OR
X110_BI2_LINE_VT_MCB_OPEN B1 O BLOCK_SECRSYN1
X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN B2
Two types of disconnector and earthing switch function blocks are available.
DCSXSWI1...3 and ESSXSWI1...2 are status only type, and DCXSWI1...2 and ESXSWI1
are controllable type. By default, the status only blocks are connected in standard
292 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
configuration. The disconnector ( CB truck) and line side earthing switch status
information is connected to DCSXSWI1 and ESSXSI1.
DCSXSWI1
X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST POSOPEN OPENPOS
X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS DCSXSWI1_OKPOS
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm, circuit-breaker spring charging and synchronizing ok
status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines if the disconnector or breaker truck is
definitely either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This output,
together with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-
enable signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for
circuit breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
Connect the addition signals required by the application for closing and
opening coil of circuit breaker.
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
Figure 480: Circuit breaker control logic: Signals for closing coil of circuit breaker 1
REF615 293
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
Figure 481: Circuit breaker control logic: Signals for opening coil of circuit breaker 1
AND6
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK B2
B3
NOT B4
B5
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT B6
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
AND
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS B1 O
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
OR6
T1PTTR1_BLK_CLOSE B1 O CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The configuration includes logic for generating circuit breaker external closing and
opening command with IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
Connect the additional signals for opening and closing of circuit breaker
in local or remote mode, if applicable for the configuration.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
294 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
CSMSQI1
REF615 295
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
RESCMMXU2
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
VSMSQI1
RESVMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU2
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
FMMXU1
PEMMXU1
RSTACM
Figure 495: Other measurement: Three phase power and energy measurement
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
296 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 1 OR
B1 O X110_BI1_BUS_VT_MCB_OPEN
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 1
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_LINE_VT_MCB_OPEN
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
REF615 297
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
X130_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING
X130 (AIM).X130-Input 1
X130_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X130 (AIM).X130-Input 2
X130_BI3_CB_OPENED
X130 (AIM).X130-Input 3
X130_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
X130 (AIM).X130-Input 4
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
VOLTAGE_AND_FREQ_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO4
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
OR
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B1 O
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B2
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
298 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED1
OR
OK
PHxPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED2
OR6
OK
EFxPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B2 RESET
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
LED3
OR6
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
T1PTTR1_OPERATE B2 RESET
PHPTOV_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
LED4
AND
OK
X130_BI3_CB_OPENED B1 O ALARM
SECRSYN1_SYNC_OK B2 RESET
LED5
OK
FREQUENCY_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
REF615 299
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
HREFPDIF1_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED9
OR6
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM B1 O ALARM
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_3PH B2 RESET
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U B3
CCSPV1_ALARM B4
SSCBR1_ALARMS B5
B6
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
300 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B1 O
PHxPTOC_OPERATE B2
TPGAPC2
IN1 OUT1 OC_OPERATE_PULSE
IN2 OUT2 EF_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O
EFxPTOC_OPERATE B2
HREFPDIF1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
Figure 503: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
OR6 TPGAPC3
PHPTOV_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1 VOLTAGE_AND_FREQ_OPERATE_PULSE
PHPTUV_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2
FREQUENCY_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 504: Timer logic for voltage and frequency operate pulse
3.13.1 Applications
The standard configuration for directional overcurrent and directional earth-fault
protection with phase voltage-based measurements, undervoltage and overvoltage
protection, frequency protection and measurement functions is mainly intended
for cable and overhead-line feeder applications in isolated or resonant-earthed
distribution networks. The configuration also includes additional options for
selecting earth-fault protection based on admittance, wattmetric or harmonic-
based principles.
The protection relay with a standard configuration is delivered from the factory
with default settings and parameters. The end-user flexibility for incoming,
outgoing and internal signal designation within the protection relay enables this
configuration to be further adapted to different primary circuit layouts and the
related functionality needs by modifying the internal functionality using PCM600.
Standard configuration L provides the highest functionality level of REF615
standard configurations supporting sensor inputs. Standard configuration L is
delivered preconfigured with directional overcurrent protection but it also supports
non-directional overcurrent protection as well as directional overpower. Depending
on the specific feeder application, the appropriate functionality can be selected and
an own configuration created with the Application Configuration tool in PCM600.
Standard configuration L is not designed for using all the available functionality
REF615 301
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
content in one IED at the same time. To ensure the performance of the IED, the
user specific configuration load is verified with the Application Configuration tool
of PCM600.
3.13.2 Functions
Lockout relay
HMI
Lockout relay
Time
Authorization
2× - Web HMI
Q>→, 3U< P>/Q> I ESC Clear
AND
3I 32Q, 27 32R/32O
O R
L
OR
2×
I2> I2/I1> 3Ith>F 3I>>>
46 46PD 49F 50P/51P
CONDITION MONITORING COMMUNICATION
AND SUPERVISION
3× 3× 3I
ARC 3I>/Io>BF Protocols:
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF IEC 61850-8-1
FUSEF CBCM MCS 3I IEC 61850-9-2LE
60 CBCM MCS 3I Modbus®
2× 2× IEC 60870-5-103
3I> 3I>> 3I>→ 3I>>→ Io Io DNP3
51P-1 51P-2 67-1 67-2 2×
UL1UL2UL3 OPTS TCS Interfaces:
OPTM TCM Ethernet: TX (RJ45), FX (LC)
Serial: Serial glass fiber (ST),
Io RS-485, RS-232
3I2f> Io>>
68 51N-2 Redundant protocols:
HSR
PRP
RSTP
Io
2× CONTROL AND INDICATION 1) MEASUREMENT
Io> Io>>>
51N-1 50N/51N - I, U, Io, P, Q, E, pf, f
Object Ctrl 2) Ind 3)
- Limit value supervision
CB 1 - - Load profile record
2 3 - Symmetrical components
DC
2×
Io>→ Io>>→ Io>IEF→ Io>→Y ES 1 2 Analog interface types 1)
67N-1 67N-2 67NIEF 67YN 1)
Check availability of binary inputs/outputs
Current sensor 3
from technical documentation
2)
Control and indication function for Voltage sensor 3
3× 3×
primary object
Yo>→ Po>→ Io>HA 3)
Status indication function for Current transformer 1
21YN 32N 51NHA primary object 1)
Combi sensor inputs with conventional Io
OR OR input
3× 3× 2× 2×
3U< U<RT U2> U1< SYNC O→I PQUUB
27 27RT 47O- 47U+ 25 79 PQVUB
UL1
3× 3× 6×
3U> Uo> VS f>/f<,
df/dt
59 59G 78V
81
REMARKS
18× Optional 3× No. of Calculated OR Alternative
FLOC MAP SOTF function instances value function to be
21FL MAP SOTF Io/Uo defined when
ordering
302 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Circuit breaker close enabled
2 Short circuit protection operated
3 Earth-fault protection operated
4 Current unbalance protection operated
5 NPS or PPS voltage protection operated
6 Overvoltage or residual overvoltage protection operated
7 Thermal overload alarm
8 Undervoltage or frequency protection operated
9 Supervision alarm
10 Circuit breaker condition monitoring alarm
11 –
REF615 303
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 U1
6 U2
7 U3
8 –
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
304 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 305
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
306 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
DPHHPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHHPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC1
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC1_START
NON_DIR
DPHLPDOC2
BLOCK OPERATE DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DPHLPDOC2_START
NON_DIR
OR6
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O DPHxPDOC_OPERATE
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B2
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second low stage of three-phase
directional overcurrent protection DPHLPDOC2 is connected to the binary output.
This signal is not connected in the configuration. This output can be used for
sending a blocking signal to the relevant overcurrent protection stage of the IED at
the infeeding bay.
OR6
DPHLPDOC2_START B1 O
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 307
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
NSPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
Three stages are provided for directional earth-fault protection. According to the
IED's order code, the directional earth-fault protection method can be based on
conventional directional earth-fault DEFxPDEF only or alternatively used together
with admittance-based earth-fault protection EFPADM or wattmetric-based earth-
fault protection WPWDE or harmonics-based earth-fault protection HAEFPTOC.
A dedicated protection stage INTRPTEF is used either for transient-based earth-
fault protection or for cable intermittent earth-fault protection in compensated
networks.
308 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
DEFLPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
DEFLPDEF2
BLOCK OPERATE DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFLPDEF2_START
RCA_CTL
DEFHPDEF1
BLOCK OPERATE DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START DEFHPDEF1_START
RCA_CTL
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O DEFxPDEF_OPERATE
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
INTRPTEF1
BLOCK OPERATE INTRPTEF1_OPERATE
START INTRPTEF1_START
BLK_EF
WPWDE1
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE1_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE1_START
WPWDE2
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE2_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE2_START
WPWDE3
BLOCK OPERATE WPWDE3_OPERATE
RCA_CTL START WPWDE3_START
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O WPWDE_OPERATE
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 309
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
EFPADM1
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM1_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM1_START
EFPADM2
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM2_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM2_START
EFPADM3
BLOCK OPERATE EFPADM3_OPERATE
RELEASE START EFPADM3_START
OR6
EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O EFPADM_OPERATE
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
310 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by a
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The same TRRET output is also connected to the binary output
X100:PO4.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4 B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5 B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3
WPWDE3_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
X110_BI4_CB_CLOSED
REF615 311
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
RST_LKOUT
312 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
to the CB spring charged binary inputs in this configuration. The open command
from the autorecloser is connected directly to binary output X100:PO3, whereas the
close command is connected directly to the binary output X100:PO2.
Set the parameters for DARREC1 properly.
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
OR6 DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B1 O INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFPADM2_OPERATE B2 INIT_5 LOCKED
WPWDE2_OPERATE B3 INIT_6 PROT_CRD
B4 DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
B5 DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
B6 DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X110_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
CBXCBR1_CLOSE_ENAD CB_READY
OR6 INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O RECL_ON
EFPADM3_OPERATE B2 SYNC
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
OR6
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B5
ARCSARCx_OPERATE B6
REF615 313
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
PHPTOV1
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV1_OPERATE
START PHPTOV1_START
PHPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV2_OPERATE
START PHPTOV2_START
PHPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE PHPTOV3_OPERATE
START PHPTOV3_START
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTOV_OPERATE
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
PHPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV1_OPERATE
START PHPTUV1_START
PHPTUV2
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV2_OPERATE
START PHPTUV2_START
PHPTUV3
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PHPTUV3_OPERATE
START PHPTUV3_START
OR6
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O PHPTUV_OPERATE
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
314 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ROVPTOV2
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV2_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV2_START
ROVPTOV3
BLOCK OPERATE ROVPTOV3_OPERATE
START ROVPTOV3_START
OR6
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ROVPTOV_OPERATE
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
NSPTOV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOV1_OPERATE
START NSPTOV1_START
PSPTUV1
SEQSPVC1_FUSEF_U BLOCK OPERATE PSPTUV1_OPERATE
START PSPTUV1_START
REF615 315
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
FRPFRQ1
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ1_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ1_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
FRPFRQ2
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ2_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ2_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
FRPFRQ3
BLOCK OPERATE FRPFRQ3_OPERATE
OPR_OFRQ
OPR_UFRQ
OPR_FRG
START FRPFRQ3_START
ST_OFRQ
ST_UFRQ
ST_FRG
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O FREQUENCY_OPERATE
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate signals from all functions are connected to minimum
pulse timer TPGAPC for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The
output from TPGAPC can be connected to binary outputs. However, these are not
connected in the configuration.
If a new protection function block is added to the configuration, check
the activation logic and add connections.
316 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6 OR6
DPHLPDOC1_START B1 O B1 O
DPHLPDOC2_START B2 B2
DPHHPDOC1_START B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4 B4
NSPTOC1_START B5 B5
NSPTOC2_START B6 B6
TPGAPC1
IN1 OUT1
IN2 OUT2
OR6 OR6 OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
DEFLPDEF2_START B2 DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2
DEFHPDEF1_START B3 DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
INTRPTEF1_START B4 NSPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFHPTOC1_START B5 NSPTOC2_OPERATE B5 B5
PDNSPTOC1_START B6 PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6 OR6
PHPTOV1_START B1 O DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_START B2 DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_START B3 DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_START B4 INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_START B5 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV1_START B6 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
PHPTUV2_START B1 O EFPADM1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_START B2 EFPADM2_OPERATE B2
ROVPTOV1_START B3 EFPADM3_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV2_START B4 ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV3_START B5 ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
B6 ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
EFPADM1_START B1 O PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O
EFPADM2_START B2 PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2
EFPADM3_START B3 PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3
WPWDE1_START B4 NSPTOV1_OPERATE B4
WPWDE2_START B5 PSPTUV1_OPERATE B5
WPWDE3_START B6 PHPTOV1_OPERATE B6
OR6 OR6
FRPFRQ1_START B1 O PHPTOV2_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_START B2 PHPTOV3_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_START B3 ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B3
B4 ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B4
B5 ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B5
B6 B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B4
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B5
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B6
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output from TRPPTRC1 trip logic functions is
available at binary output X100:PO3. The trip logic functions are provided with a
lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration setting.
If the lockout operation mode is required, the binary input has been assigned to
RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a push button.
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3..4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
REF615 317
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
WPWDE1_OPERATE B1 O
WPWDE2_OPERATE B2
WPWDE3_OPERATE B3
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B4
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B5
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B3
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B4
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B5
B6
318 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3
EFPADM1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM2_OPERATE B5
EFPADM3_OPERATE B6
OR6
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B4
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B5
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B2
WPWDE1_OPERATE B3
WPWDE2_OPERATE B4
WPWDE3_OPERATE B5
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B4
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B5
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B6
OR6
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O
PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B4
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B5
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B6
REF615 319
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6
DEFLPDEF1_START B1 O
B2
B3
B4
B5 RDRE1
B6
DPHLPDOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED
DPHLPDOC2_START C2
DPHHPDOC1_START C3
PHIPTOC1_START C4
OR6 NSPTOC1_START C5
NSPTOC2_START C6
DEFLPDEF2_START B1 O C7
B2 C8
B3 C9
B4 INTRPTEF1_START C10
B5 EFHPTOC1_START C11
B6 PDNSPTOC1_START C12
T1PTTR1_START C13
OR6 PHPTOV1_START C14
PHPTOV2_START C15
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O OR6 PHPTOV3_START C16
DPHHPDOC1_OPERATE B2 PSPTUV1_START C17
DPHLPDOC1_OPERATE B3 DEFHPDEF1_START B1 O NSPTOV1_START C18
DPHLPDOC2_OPERATE B4 B2 PHPTUV1_START C19
B5 B3 PHPTUV2_START C20
B6 B4 PHPTUV3_START C21
B5 ROVPTOV1_START C22
B6 ROVPTOV2_START C23
ROVPTOV3_START C24
CCBRBRF1_TRRET C25
OR CCBRBRF1_TRBU C26
C27
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O C28
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 C29
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE C30
OR6 EFHPTOC1_OPERATE C31
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE C32
PHPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O INRPHAR1_BLK2H C33
OR6 OR PHPTOV2_OPERATE B2 T1PTTR1_OPERATE C34
PHPTOV3_OPERATE B3 C35
DEFHPDEF1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O B4 C36
DEFLPDEF1_OPERATE B2 B2 B5 C37
DEFLPDEF2_OPERATE B3 B6 SEQPVC1_FUSEF_3PH C38
B4 SEQPVC1_FUSEF_U C39
B5 CCSPVC1_FAIL C40
B6 X110_BI4_CB_CLOSED C41
X110_BI3_CB_OPENED C42
OR6 C43
C44
PHPTUV1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC1_OPERATE C45
PHPTUV2_OPERATE B2 ARCSARC2_OPERATE C46
PHPTUV3_OPERATE B3 ARCSARC3_OPERATE C47
B4 DARREC1_INPRO C48
B5 FRPFRQ1_START C49
B6 FRPFRQ2_START C50
OR6 FRPFRQ3_START C51
C52
ROVPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O C53
ROVPTOV2_OPERATE B2 C54
ROVPTOV3_OPERATE B3 OR6 C55
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4 C56
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5 ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O C57
B6 ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2 C58
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3 C59
B4 C60
B5 C61
B6 C62
OR C63
C64
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B1 O
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL B2
OR6
FRPFRQ1_OPERATE B1 O
FRPFRQ2_OPERATE B2
FRPFRQ3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
The fuse failure supervision SEQSPVC1 detects failures in the voltage measurement
circuits. Failures, such as an open MCB, raise an alarm.
SEQSPVC1
BLOCK FUSEF_3PH SEQPVC1_FUSEF_3PH
X110_BI4_CB_CLOSED CB_CLOSED FUSEF_U SEQPVC1_FUSEF_U
DISCON_OPEN
MINCB_OPEN
320 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X110_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
X110_BI2_CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI2_CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_CHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. The functions are
blocked by the master trip, TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2, and the binary input X110:BI1
indicating IED plug out.
It is assumed that there is an external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
REF615 321
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X110_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
AND6
CBXCBR1_OPENPOS B1 O DC1_CLOSE_ENABLE
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
Connect the additional signals for the application for closing of earthing
switch.
322 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI7_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI8_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
OR6
X110_BI1_PLUG_OUT B1 O ES1_CLOSE_ENABLED
X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm and circuit-breaker spring charging status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines whether disconnector or breaker truck is
either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This output, together
with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-enable
signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for circuit
breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
CBXCBR1
X110_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X110_BI4_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS CBXCBR1_OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD CBXCBR1_CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
Connect the additional signals required for the application for closing
and opening of circuit breaker.
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
Figure 541: Circuit breaker control logic: Signal for closing coil of circuit breaker 1
REF615 323
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 542: Circuit breaker control logic: Signal for opening coil of circuit breaker 1
AND6
CB_SPRING_CHARGED B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
B2
NOT B3
B4
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT B5
B6
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
AND
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS B1 O
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
TCSSCBR_ALARM
OR6
T1PTTR1_BLK_CLOSE B1 O CBXCBR1_BLK_CLOSE
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The configuration includes logic for generating circuit breaker external closing and
opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
Connect the additional signal for closing and opening of circuit breaker
in local or remote mode if applicable for the configuration.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
324 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
CSMSQI1
REF615 325
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
VSMSQI1
FMMXU1
PEMMXU1
RSTACM
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
326 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 1 OR
B1 O X110_BI1_PLUG_OUT
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 1
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_CB_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
REF615 327
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
CBXCBR1_CLOSE_ENAD
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
DC1_CLOSE_ENABLE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
ES1_CLOSE_ENABLED
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
CCBRBRF1_TRRET
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
328 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED1
OK
CBXCBR1_CLOSE_ENAD ALARM
RESET
LED2
OR
OK
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED3
OR6
OK
B1 O ALARM
B2 RESET
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B3
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B4
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5
B6
LED4
OR6
OK
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 RESET
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
LED5
OR
OK
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B2 RESET
REF615 329
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED6
OR
OK
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PHPTOV_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED7
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
LED8
OR
OK
PHPTUV_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
FRPFRQ_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED9
OR6
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM B1 O ALARM
SEQPVC1_FUSEF_3PH B2 RESET
SEQPVC1_FUSEF_U B3
CCSPVC1_ALARM B4
B5
B6
LED10
OR
OK
CB_OPEN_COMMAND B1 O ALARM
SSCBR1_ALARMS B2 RESET
330 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR TPGAPC2
DPHxPDOC_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2
OR6
DEFxPDEF_OPERATE B1 O
ROVPTOV_OPERATE B2
INTRPTEF1_OPERATE B3
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B4
EFPADM_OPERATE B5
WPWDE_OPERATE B6
Figure 560: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
OR6 TPGAPC3
PHPTOV_OPERATE B1 O IN1 OUT1
PHPTUV_OPERATE B2 IN2 OUT2
FRPFRQ_OPERATE B3
PSPTUV1_OPERATE B4
NSPTOV1_OPERATE B5
B6
Figure 561: Timer logic for voltage and frequency operate pulse
3.14.1 Applications
The standard configuration N provides the highest functionality level of all the
REF615 standard configurations. Standard configuration N is delivered as pre-
configured with the same configuration as standard configuration D. Standard
configuration N provides the possibility to standardize on one type of REF615.
Depending on the specific feeder application, the appropriate functionality can
be selected and an own configuration created with the Application Configuration
tool in PCM600. Standard configuration N is not designed to utilize at once all
the available functionality content in one IED. To ensure the performance of the
IED, the user specific configuration load needs to be verified with the Application
Configuration tool in PCM600.
REF615 331
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
3.14.2 Functions
UL1UL2UL3
Uo
U12 0. 0 kV
O R
L - Time synchronization: IEEE 1588 v2,
SNTP, IRIG-B
P 0.00 kW
Q 0.00 kVAr
IL2 0 A
- User management
2× - Web HMI
Q>→, 3U< P>/Q> I ESC Clear
AND
3I 32Q, 27 32R/32O
O R
L
OR
3× 2×
I2> I2/I1> 3Ith>F 3I>>>
46 46PD 49F 50P/51P
CONDITION MONITORING COMMUNICATION
Io AND SUPERVISION
3×
ARC 3I>/Io>BF Protocols:
50L/50NL 51BF/51NBF IEC 61850-8-1/-9-2LE
3I FUSEF CBCM MCS 3I Modbus®
60 CBCM MCS 3I Io IEC 60870-5-103
2× 2× DNP3
U12 3I> 3I>> 3I>→ 3I>>→ Interfaces:
51P-1 51P-2 67-1 67-2 * * * Ethernet: TX (RJ45), FX (LC)
MCS I_A MCS I_B MCS I_C
MCS I_A MCS I_B MCS I_C Serial: Serial glass fiber (ST),
RS-485, RS-232
3I2f> Redundant protocols:
68 2× HSR
OPTS TCS PRP
OPTM TCM RSTP
Io
2×
Io>>> Io> Io>> PHIZ CONTROL AND INDICATION 1) MEASUREMENT
50N/51N 51N-1 51N-2 HIZ
Object Ctrl 2) Ind 3) - I, U, Io, Uo, P, Q, E, pf, f
- Limit value supervision
CB 1 -
Uo - Load profile record
2× DC 2 3 - RTD/mA measurement (optional)
Io>→ Io>>→ Io>IEF→ Io>→Y - Symmetrical components
67N-1 67N-2 67NIEF 67YN ES 1 2
1)
Check availability of binary inputs/outputs Analog interface types 1)
from technical documentation
3× 3× 2)
Control and indication function for Current transformer 4
Yo>→ Po>→ Io>HA primary object
21YN 32N 51NHA Voltage transformer 5
3)
Status indication function for
OR OR primary object 1)
Conventional transformer inputs
UL1UL2UL3
UL1UL2UL3
3× 3× 2× 2×
3U< U<RT U2> U1< SYNC O→I PQM3I PQM3U PQMU
27 27RT 47O- 47U+ 25 79 PQM3I PQM3V PQMV
U12
3× 3× 6×
3U> Uo> VS f>/f<, PQUUB
df/dt PQVUB
59 59G 78V
81
REMARKS
FLOC dHi_A> dHi_B> dHi_C>
Optional 3× No. of * Reserves the 3I inputs for the
21FL 87A 87B 87C
* * * function instances high-impedance based differential
purpose when this functionality is used
18×
MAP SOTF Alternative
OR
MAP SOTF Calculated function to be
2xRTD value defined when
1xmA Io/Uo
ordering
332 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED Description
1 Non-directional overcurrent operate
2 Non-directional earth-fault operate
3 Sensitive earth-fault operate
4 Negative sequence overcurrent or phase discontinuity
Table continues on the next page
REF615 333
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED Description
5 Thermal overload alarm
6 Breaker failure operate
7 Disturbance recorder triggered
8 Circuit breaker condition monitoring alarm
9 Trip circuit supervision alarm
10 Arc protection operate
11 Autoreclose in progress
Channel Description
1 IL1
2 IL2
3 IL3
4 Io
5 –
6 –
7 –
8 –
9 –
10 –
11 –
12 –
334 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 335
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The phase voltages to the protection relay are fed from a voltage transformer. The
residual voltage to the protection relay is fed from either residually connected VTs,
an open delta connected VT or calculated internally.
The protection relay offers six different setting groups which can be set based
on individual needs. Each group can be activated or deactivated using the setting
group settings available in the protection relay.
Depending on the communication protocol the required function block needs to be
instantiated in the configuration.
PHHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHHPTOC1_START
PHLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC1_START
PHLPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE PHLPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START PHLPTOC2_START
OR6
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O PHxPTOC_OPERATE
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B3
PHLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
B5
B6
The upstream blocking from the start of the second low stage of three-phase
non-directional overcurrent protection PHLPTOC2 is connected to the binary output
X110:SO1. This output can be used for sending a blocking signal to the relevant
overcurrent protection stage of the IED at the infeeding bay.
336 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
OR6
PHLPTOC2_START B1 O UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
The output BLK2H of three-phase inrush detector INRPHAR1 enables either blocking
the function or multiplying the active settings for any of the available overcurrent or
earth-fault function blocks.
INRPHAR1
BLOCK BLK2H INRPHAR1_BLK2H
NSPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE NSPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START NSPTOC2_START
OR
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O NSPTOC_OPERATE
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Four non-directional earth-fault stages and three directional earth-fault stages are
offered earth-fault protection. However in the configuration three non-directional
earth fault stages are considered. One stage is dedicated to sensitive earth-fault
protection EFLPTOC2. According to the IED's order code, the directional earth-fault
protection method can be based on conventional directional earth-fault DEFxPDEF
only or alternatively used together with admittance-based earth-fault protection
EFPADM, wattmetric-based earth-fault protection WPWDE or harmonics-based
earth-fault protection HAEFPTOC. A dedicated protection stage INTRPTEF is used
either for transient based earth-fault protection or for cable intermittent earth-fault
protection in compensated networks.
REF615 337
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
EFIPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFIPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFIPTOC1_START
EFHPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFHPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFHPTOC1_START
EFLPTOC1
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC1_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC1_START
OR6
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O EFxPTOC_OPERATE
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
EFLPTOC2
BLOCK OPERATE EFLPTOC2_OPERATE
ENA_MULT START EFLPTOC2_START
Circuit breaker failure protection CCBRBRF1 is initiated via the START input by
number of different protection functions available in the IED. The breaker failure
protection function offers different operating modes associated with the circuit
breaker position and the measured phase and residual currents.
338 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
The circuit breaker failure protection function has two operating outputs: TRRET
and TRBU. The TRRET operate output is used for retripping its own breaker through
TRPPTRC2_TRIP. The TRBU output is used to give a backup trip to the breaker
feeding upstream. For this purpose, the TRBU operate output signal is connected to
the binary output X100:PO2.
CCBRBRF1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK CB_FAULT_AL
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O START TRBU CCBRBRF1_TRBU
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 POSCLOSE TRRET CCBRBRF1_TRRET
PHLPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3 CB_FAULT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
REF615 339
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
ARCSARC1
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC1_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC2
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC2_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
ARCSARC3
BLOCK OPERATE ARCSARC3_OPERATE
REM_FLT_ARC ARC_FLT_DET ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET
OPR_MODE
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O ARCSARC_OPERATE
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
TRPPTRC3
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC3_TRIP
ARCSARC1_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC4
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC4_TRIP
ARCSARC2_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
TRPPTRC5
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC5_TRIP
ARCSARC3_OPERATE OPERATE CL_LKOUT
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT RST_LKOUT
340 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
The circuit breaker availability for the autoreclosing sequence is expressed with the
CB_READY input in DARREC1. The signal, and other required signals, are connected
to the CB spring charged binary inputs in this configuration. The open command
from the autorecloser is connected directly to binary output X100:PO3, whereas the
close command is connected directly to the binary output X100:PO1.
DARREC1
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_1 OPEN_CB DARREC1_OPEN_CB
PHLPTOC2_OPERATE INIT_2 CLOSE_CB DARREC1_CLOSE_CB
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_3 CMD_WAIT
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_4 INPRO DARREC1_INPRO
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE INIT_5 LOCKED
X110_BI2_EXT_START_AUTORECLOSE INIT_6 PROT_CRD
DEL_INIT_2 UNSUC_RECL DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL
DEL_INIT_3 AR_ON
DEL_INIT_4 READY
BLK_RECL_T ACTIVE
BLK_RCLM_T
BLK_THERM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED CB_POS
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED CB_READY
INC_SHOTP
INHIBIT_RECL
OR6 RECL_ON
SYNC
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B3
CBXCBR1_SELECTED B4
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM B5 OR
B6
B1 O
B2
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
General start and operate from all the functions are connected to minimum pulse
timer TPGAPC1 for setting the minimum pulse length for the outputs. The output
from TPGAPC1 is connected to binary outputs
OR6
PHLPTOC1_START B1 O
PHHPTOC1_START B2
PHLPTOC2_START B3
PHIPTOC1_START B4
NSPTOC1_START B5
NSPTOC2_START B6
OR6
OR6
B1 O
EFLPTOC1_START B1 O B2
EFLPTOC2_START B2 B3
EFIPTOC1_START B3 B4
EFHPTOC1_START B4 B5 TPGAPC1
PDNSPTOC1_START B5 B6
B6 IN1 OUT1 GENERAL_START_PULSE
IN2 OUT2 GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
OR6 OR6
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2
PHLPTOC2_OPERATE B3 B3
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B4
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
REF615 341
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
The operate signals from the protection functions are connected to the two trip
logics TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2. The output of these trip logic functions is available
at binary output X100:PO3 and X100:PO4. The trip logic functions are provided
with a lockout and latching function, event generation and the trip signal duration
setting. If the lockout operation mode is selected, binary input X120:BI4 has been
assigned to RST_LKOUT input of both the trip logic to enable external reset with a
push button.
Three other trip logics TRPPTRC3...4 are also available if the IED is ordered with high
speed binary outputs options.
TRPPTRC1
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC1_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHLPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B5
B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
TRPPTRC2
OR6 OR6
BLOCK TRIP TRPPTRC2_TRIP
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O B1 O OPERATE CL_LKOUT
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B2 B2 RST_LKOUT
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B3 B3
PHLPTOC2_OPERATE B4 B4
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B5 B5
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B6 B6
OR6
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B3
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B4
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B5
CCBRBRF1_TRRET B6
OR6
ARCSARC1_OPERATE B1 O
ARCSARC2_OPERATE B2
ARCSARC3_OPERATE B3
B4
B5
B6
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
342 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
RDRE1
PHLPTOC1_START C1 TRIGGERED DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED
PHHPTOC1_START C2
PHLPTOC2_START C3
PHIPTOC1_START C4
NSPTOC1_START C5
NSPTOC2_START C6
EFLPTOC1_START C7
EFHPTOC1_START C8
EFIPTOC1_START C9
EFLPTOC2_START C10
C11
PDNSPTOC1_START C12
T1PTTR1_START C13
OR6 CCBRBRF1_TRRET C14
CCBRBRF1_TRBU C15
PHIPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O C16
PHHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 C17
PHLPTOC2_OPERATE B3 C18
PHLPTOC1_OPERATE B4 X110_BI2_EXT_START_AUTORECLOSE C19
B5 EFLPTOC2_OPERATE C20
B6 PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE C21
INRPHAR1_BLK2H C22
T1PTTR1_OPERATE C23
C24
ARCSARC1_OPERATE C25
OR ARCSARC2_OPERATE C26
ARCSARC3_OPERATE C27
NSPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O DARREC1_INPRO C28
NSPTOC2_OPERATE B2 DARREC1_CLOSE_CB C29
DARREC1_UNSUC_RECL C30
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING C31
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED C32
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED C33
OR6 C34
C35
EFLPTOC1_OPERATE B1 O C36
EFHPTOC1_OPERATE B2 C37
EFIPTOC1_OPERATE B3 C38
B4 C39
B5 C40
B6 C41
C42
C43
C44
C45
OR6 C46
C47
ARCSARC1_ARC_FLT_DET B1 O C48
ARCSARC2_ARC_FLT_DET B2 C49
ARCSARC3_ARC_FLT_DET B3 C50
B4 C51
B5 C52
B6 C53
C54
C55
C56
C57
C58
C59
C60
C61
C62
C63
C64
SSCBR1
BLOCK TRV_T_OP_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN TRV_T_CL_ALM SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE SPR_CHR_ALM SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM
CB_OPEN_COMMAND OPEN_CB_EXE OPR_ALM SSCBR1_OPR_ALM
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND CLOSE_CB_EXE OPR_LO SSCBR1_OPR_LO
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM PRES_ALM_IN IPOW_ALM SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM
PRES_LO_IN IPOW_LO SSCBR1_IPOW_LO
CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED SPR_CHR_ST CB_LIFE_ALM SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED SPR_CHR MON_ALM SSCBR1_MON_ALM
RST_IPOW PRES_ALM SSCBR1_PRES_ALM
RST_CB_WEAR PRES_LO SSCBR1_PRES_LO
RST_TRV_T OPENPOS
RST_SPR_T INVALIDPOS
CLOSEPOS
REF615 343
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR6
SSCBR1_TRV_T_OP_ALM B1 O
SSCBR1_TRV_T_CL_ALM B2
SSCBR1_SPR_CHR_ALM B3
SSCBR1_OPR_ALM B4
SSCBR1_OPR_LO B5 OR
SSCBR1_IPOW_ALM B6
B1 O SSCBR1_ALARMS
B2
OR6
SSCBR1_IPOW_LO B1 O
SSCBR1_CB_LIFE_ALM B2
SSCBR1_MON_ALM B3
SSCBR1_PRES_ALM B4
SSCBR1_PRES_LO B5
B6
NOT
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED IN OUT CB_SPRING_DISCHARGED
Two separate trip circuit supervision functions are included: TCSSCBR1 for power
output X100:PO3 and TCSSCBR2 for power output X100:PO4. Both functions are
blocked by the master trip TRPPTRC1 and TRPPTRC2 and the circuit breaker open
signal.
It is assumed that there is no external resistor in the circuit breaker
tripping coil circuit connected in parallel with the circuit breaker normally
open auxiliary contact.
TCSSCBR1
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR1_ALARM
TCSSCBR2
TCSSCBR_BLOCKING BLOCK ALARM TCSSCBR2_ALARM
OR
TCSSCBR1_ALARM B1 O TCSSCBR_ALARM
TCSSCBR2_ALARM B2
OR6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B1 O TCSSCBR_BLOCKING
TRPPTRC2_TRIP B2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED B3
B4
B5
B6
344 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
ESSXSWI1
X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED POSOPEN OPENPOS ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS
X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED POSCLOSE CLOSEPOS
OKPOS
The circuit breaker closing is enabled when the ENA_CLOSE input is activated. The
input can be activated by the configuration logic, which is a combination of the
disconnector or breaker truck and earth-switch position status, status of the trip
logics, gas pressure alarm and circuit-breaker spring charging status.
The OKPOS output from DCSXSWI defines whether the disconnector or breaker truck
is either open (in test position) or close (in service position). This output, together
with the open earth-switch and non-active trip signals, activates the close-enable
signal to the circuit breaker control function block. The open operation for circuit
breaker is always enabled.
The SYNC_ITL_BYP input can be used, for example, to always enable the closing
of the circuit breaker when the circuit breaker truck is in the test position.
SYNC_ITL_BYP overrides, for example, active interlocking conditions when the
circuit breaker truck is closed in service position.
CBXCBR1
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED POSOPEN SELECTED CBXCBR1_SELECTED
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED POSCLOSE EXE_OP CBXCBR1_EXE_OP
TRUE ENA_OPEN EXE_CL CBXCBR1_EXE_CL
CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE ENA_CLOSE OP_REQ
FALSE BLK_OPEN CL_REQ
BLK_CLOSE OPENPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_OPEN AU_OPEN CLOSEPOS
CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE AU_CLOSE OKPOS
TRIP OPEN_ENAD
SYNC_OK CLOSE_ENAD
SYNC_ITL_BYP
Connect the addition signals required for the application for closing and
opening of circuit breaker.
REF615 345
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
OR
CBXCBR1_EXE_CL B1 O CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
DARREC1_CLOSE_CB B2
Figure 586: Circuit breaker control logic: Signals for closing coil of circuit breaker
OR6
CBXCBR1_EXE_OP B1 O CB_OPEN_COMMAND
TRPPTRC1_TRIP B2
DARREC1_OPEN_CB B3
B4
B5
B6
Figure 587: Circuit breaker control logic: Signals for opening coil of circuit breaker
AND6
DCSXSWI1_OKPOS B1 O CBXCBR1_ENA_CLOSE
ESSXSWI1_OPENPOS B2
X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED B3
B4
NOT B5
B6
TRPPTRC1_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
TRPPTRC2_TRIP IN OUT
NOT
X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM IN OUT
The configuration includes the logic for generating circuit breaker external closing
and opening command with the IED in local or remote mode.
Check the logic for the external circuit breaker closing command and
modify it according to the application.
Connect the additional signal for closing and opening of circuit breaker
in local or remote mode if applicable for the configuration.
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXCBR1_AU_CLOSE
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
AND
CONTROL_LOCAL B1 O
FALSE B2
OR
B1 O CBXBCR1_AU_OPEN
B2
AND
CONTROL_REMOTE B1 O
FALSE B2
346 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
CSMSQI1
RESCMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
VMMXU1
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
REF615 347
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
VSMSQI1
VMMXU2
BLOCK HIGH_ALARM
HIGH_WARN
LOW_WARN
LOW_ALARM
FMMXU1
PEMMXU1
RSTACM
FLTRFRC1
BLOCK
CB_CLRD
LDPRLRC1
RSTMEM MEM_WARN
MEM_ALARM
348 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 2 OR
B1 O X110_BI2_EXT_START_AUTORECLOSE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 2
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 3 OR
B1 O X110_BI3_GAS_PRESSURE_ALARM
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 3
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 4 OR
B1 O X110_BI4_CB_SPRING_CHARGED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 4
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 5 OR
B1 O X110_BI5_CB_TRUCK_IN_SERVICE
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 5
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 6 OR
B1 O X110_BI6_CB_TRUCK_IN_TEST
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 6
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 7 OR
B1 O X110_BI7_ES1_CLOSED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 7
X110 (BIO).X110-Input 8 OR
B1 O X110_BI8_ES1_OPENED
B2
X110 (BIO-H).X110-Input 8
X120_BI1_EXT_OC_BLOCKING
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 1
X120_BI2_CB_CLOSED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 2
X120_BI3_CB_OPENED
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 3
X120_BI4_RST_LOCKOUT
X120 (AIM).X120-Input 4
REF615 349
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
UPSTEAM_OC_BLOCKING
X110 (BIO).X110-SO1
TRPPTRC3_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO1
OC_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO2
TRPPTRC4_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO2
EF_OPERATE_PULSE
X110 (BIO).X110-SO3
TRPPTRC5_TRIP
X110 (BIO-H).X110-HSO3
CB_CLOSE_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO1
CCBRBRF1_TRBU
X100 (PSM).X100-PO2
GENERAL_START_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO1
GENERAL_OPERATE_PULSE
X100 (PSM).X100-SO2
CB_OPEN_COMMAND
X100 (PSM).X100-PO3
TRPPTRC2_TRIP
X100 (PSM).X100-PO4
350 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
LED1
OK
PHxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED2
OK
EFxPTOC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED3
OK
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED4
OR
OK
NSPTOC_OPERATE B1 O ALARM
PDNSPTOC1_OPERATE B2 RESET
LED5
OK
T1PTTR1_ALARM ALARM
RESET
REF615 351
Application Manual
REF615 standard configurations 1MRS756378 U
LED6
OK
CCBRBRF1_TRBU ALARM
RESET
LED7
OK
DISTURB_RECORD_TRIGGERED ALARM
RESET
LED8
OK
SSCBR1_ALARMS ALARM
RESET
LED9
OK
TCSSCBR_ALARM ALARM
RESET
LED10
OK
ARCSARC_OPERATE ALARM
RESET
LED11
OK
DARREC1_INPRO ALARM
RESET
OR
EFxPTOC_OPERATE B1 O
EFLPTOC2_OPERATE B2
Figure 606: Timer logic for overcurrent and earth-fault operate pulse
352 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U REF615 standard configurations
REF615 353
Application Manual
Requirements for measurement 1MRS756378 U
transformers
Table 71: Limits of errors according to IEC 60044-1 for protective current trans-
formers
The accuracy classes 5P and 10P are both suitable for non-directional overcurrent
protection. The 5P class provides a better accuracy. This should be noted also
if there are accuracy requirements for the metering functions (current metering,
power metering, and so on) of the protection relay.
354 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Requirements for measurement
transformers
The CT accuracy primary limit current describes the highest fault current magnitude
at which the CT fulfils the specified accuracy. Beyond this level, the secondary
current of the CT is distorted and it might have severe effects on the performance
of the protection relay.
In practise, the actual accuracy limit factor (Fa) differs from the rated accuracy limit
factor (Fn) and is proportional to the ratio of the rated CT burden and the actual CT
burden.
The actual accuracy limit factor is calculated using the formula:
Sin + Sn
Fa ≈ Fn ×
Sin + S
REF615 355
Application Manual
Requirements for measurement 1MRS756378 U
transformers
The maximum three-phase fault current is 41.7 kA and the minimum three-phase
short circuit current is 22.8 kA. The actual accuracy limit factor of the CT is
calculated to be 59.
The start current setting for low-set stage (3I>) is selected to be about twice the
nominal current of the cable. The operate time is selected so that it is selective with
the next protection relay (not visible in Figure 607). The settings for the high-set
stage and instantaneous stage are defined also so that grading is ensured with the
downstream protection. In addition, the start current settings have to be defined so
356 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Requirements for measurement
transformers
that the protection relay operates with the minimum fault current and it does not
operate with the maximum load current. The settings for all three stages are as in
Figure 607.
For the application point of view, the suitable setting for instantaneous stage
(I>>>) in this example is 3 500 A (5.83 × I2n). I2n is the 1.2 multiple with nominal
primary current of the CT. For the CT characteristics point of view, the criteria given
by the current transformer selection formula is fulfilled and also the protection relay
setting is considerably below the Fa. In this application, the CT rated burden could
have been selected much lower than 10 VA for economical reasons.
REF615 357
Application Manual
Protection relay's physical connections 1MRS756378 U
5.1 Inputs
Terminal Description
X120:7-8 IL1
X120:9-10 IL2
X120:11-12 IL3
Terminal Description
X120:13-14 Io
Terminal Description
X120:5-6 IoB4
X120:13-14 Io
Terminal Description
X130:1-2 Io
358 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Protection relay's physical connections
Terminal Description
X130:11-12 U1
X130:13-14 U2
X130:15-16 U3
Terminal Description
X130:9-10 U12B
Terminal Description
X120:5-6 Uo
Terminal Description
X130:17-18 Uo
Terminal Description
X131 IL1
U1
X132 IL2
U2
X133 IL3
U3
REF615 359
Application Manual
Protection relay's physical connections 1MRS756378 U
Terminal Description
X100:1 + Input
X100:2 - Input
Terminal Description
X110:1 BI1, +
X110:2 BI1, -
X110:3 BI2, +
X110:4 BI2, -
X110:5 BI3, +
X110:6 BI3, -
X110:6 BI4, -
X110:7 BI4, +
X110:8 BI5, +
X110:9 BI5, -
X110:9 BI6, -
X110:10 BI6, +
X110:11 BI7, +
X110:12 BI7, -
X110:12 BI8, -
X110:13 BI8, +
Terminal Description
X110:1 BI1, +
X110:5 BI1, -
X110:2 BI2, +
X110:5 BI2, -
X110:3 BI3, +
X110:5 BI3, -
X110:4 BI4, +
X110:5 BI4, -
Table continues on the next page
360 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Protection relay's physical connections
Terminal Description
X110:6 BI5, +
X110:10 BI5, -
X110:7 BI6, +
X110:10 BI6, -
X110:8 BI7, +
X110:10 BI7, -
X110:9 BI8, +
X110:10 BI8, -
Terminal Description
X120:1 BI1, +
X120:2 BI1, -
X120:3 BI2, +
X120:2 BI2, -
X120:4 BI3, +
X120:2 BI3, -
X120:5 BI4, +
X120:6 BI4, -
Terminal Description
X120:1 BI1, +
X120:2 BI1, -
X120:3 BI2, +
X120:2 BI2, -
X120:4 BI3, +
X120:2 BI3, -
Terminal Description
X130:1 BI1, +
X130:2 BI1, -
X130:2 BI2, -
X130:3 BI2, +
X130:4 BI3, +
X130:5 BI3, -
Table continues on the next page
REF615 361
Application Manual
Protection relay's physical connections 1MRS756378 U
Terminal Description
X130:5 BI4, -
X130:6 BI4, +
X130:7 BI5, +
X130:8 BI5, -
X130:8 BI6, -
X130:9 BI6, +
Binary inputs of slot X130 are available with configuration K and optionally available
with configurations E, F, H, J and N.
Terminal Description
X130:1 BI1, +
X130:2 BI1, -
X130:3 BI2, +
X130:4 BI2, -
X130:5 BI3, +
X130:6 BI3, -
X130:7 BI4, +
X130:8 BI4, -
Terminal Description
X13 Input Light sensor 1
X14 Input Light sensor 2
X15 Input Light sensor 3
362 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Protection relay's physical connections
Terminal Description
X130:1 mA1 (AI1), +
X130:2 mA1 (AI1), -
X130:3 mA2 (AI2), +
X130:4 mA2 (AI2), -
X130:5 RTD1 (AI3), +
X130:6 RTD1 (AI3), -
X130:7 RTD2 (AI4), +
X130:8 RTD2 (AI4), -
X130:9 RTD3 (AI5), +
X130:10 RTD3 (AI5), -
X130:11 Common5
X130:12 Common6
X130:13 RTD4 (AI6), +
X130:14 RTD4 (AI6), -
X130:15 RTD5 (AI7), +
X130:16 RTD5 (AI7), -
X130:17 RTD6 (AI8), +
X130:18 RTD6 (AI8), -
Terminal Description
X130:1 mA1 (AI1), +
X130:2 mA1 (AI1), -
X130:3 RTD1 (AI2), +
X130:4 RTD1 (AI2), -
X130:5 RTD1 (AI2), ground
X130:6 RTD2 (AI3), +
X130:7 RTD2 (AI3), -
X130:8 RTD2 (AI3), ground
5.2 Outputs
REF615 363
Application Manual
Protection relay's physical connections 1MRS756378 U
Terminal Description
X100:6 PO1, NO
X100:7 PO1, NO
X100:8 PO2, NO
X100:9 PO2, NO
X100:15 PO3, NO (TCS resistor)
X100:16 PO3, NO
X100:17 PO3, NO
X100:18 PO3 (TCS1 input), NO
X100:19 PO3 (TCS1 input), NO
X100:20 PO4, NO (TCS resistor)
X100:21 PO4, NO
X100:22 PO4, NO
X100:23 PO4 (TCS2 input), NO
X100:24 PO4 (TCS2 input), NO
Terminal Description
X100:10 SO1, common
X100:11 SO1, NC
X100:12 SO1, NO
X100:13 SO2, NO
X100:14 SO2, NO
Terminal Description
X110:14 SO1, common
X110:15 SO1, NO
X110:16 SO1, NC
X110:17 SO2, common
X110:18 SO2, NO
X110:19 SO2, NC
X110:20 SO3, common
Table continues on the next page
364 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Protection relay's physical connections
Terminal Description
X110:21 SO3, NO
X110:22 SO3, NC
X110:23 SO4, common
X110:24 SO4, NO
Terminal Description
X110:15 HSO1, NO
X110:16 HSO1, NO
X110:19 HSO2, NO
X110:20 HSO2, NO
X110:23 HSO3, NO
X110:24 HSO3, NO
Output contacts of slot X130 are available in the optional BIO module (BIO0006).
Output contacts of slot X130 are optional for configurations B and D.
Terminal Description
X130:10 SO1, common
X130:11 SO1, NO
X130:12 SO1, NC
X130:13 SO2, common
X130:14 SO2, NO
X130:15 SO2, NC
X130:16 SO3, common
X130:17 SO3, NO
X130:18 SO3, NC
5.2.3 IRF
The IRF contact functions as an output contact for the self-supervision system of
the protection relay. Under normal operating conditions, the protection relay is
energized and the contact is closed (X100:3-5). When a fault is detected by the self-
supervision system or the auxiliary voltage is disconnected, the contact X100:3-5
drops off and the contact X100:3-4 closes.
Terminal Description
X100:3 IRF, common
X100:4 Closed; IRF, or U aux disconnected
X100:5 Closed; no IRF, and U aux connected
REF615 365
Application Manual
Glossary 1MRS756378 U
6 Glossary
100BASE-FX A physical medium defined in the IEEE 802.3 Ethernet standard for local
area networks (LANs) that uses fiber optic cabling
100BASE-TX A physical medium defined in the IEEE 802.3 Ethernet standard for local
area networks (LANs) that uses twisted-pair cabling category 5 or higher
with RJ-45 connectors
615 series Series of numerical protection and control relays for protection and su-
pervision applications of utility substations, and industrial switchgear
and equipment
AC Alternating current
AI Analog input
ASCII American Standard Code for Information Interchange
BI Binary input
BIO Binary input and output
BO Binary output
CB Circuit breaker
CT Current transformer
DAN Doubly attached node
DC 1. Direct current
2. Disconnector
3. Double command
366 REF615
Application Manual
1MRS756378 U Glossary
REF615 367
Application Manual
Glossary 1MRS756378 U
368 REF615
Application Manual
—
ABB Distribution Solutions
Digital Substation Products
P.O. Box 699
FI-65101 VAASA, Finland
Phone +358 10 22 11
www.abb.com/mediumvoltage
www.abb.com/relion
www.abb.com/substationautomation
1MRS756378 U